1 /* SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-2.0-only */ 2 /* 3 * mac80211 <-> driver interface 4 * 5 * Copyright 2002-2005, Devicescape Software, Inc. 6 * Copyright 2006-2007 Jiri Benc <jbenc@suse.cz> 7 * Copyright 2007-2010 Johannes Berg <johannes@sipsolutions.net> 8 * Copyright 2013-2014 Intel Mobile Communications GmbH 9 * Copyright (C) 2015 - 2017 Intel Deutschland GmbH 10 * Copyright (C) 2018 - 2023 Intel Corporation 11 */ 12 13 #ifndef MAC80211_H 14 #define MAC80211_H 15 16 #include <linux/bug.h> 17 #include <linux/kernel.h> 18 #include <linux/if_ether.h> 19 #include <linux/skbuff.h> 20 #include <linux/ieee80211.h> 21 #include <linux/lockdep.h> 22 #include <net/cfg80211.h> 23 #include <net/codel.h> 24 #include <net/ieee80211_radiotap.h> 25 #include <asm/unaligned.h> 26 27 /** 28 * DOC: Introduction 29 * 30 * mac80211 is the Linux stack for 802.11 hardware that implements 31 * only partial functionality in hard- or firmware. This document 32 * defines the interface between mac80211 and low-level hardware 33 * drivers. 34 */ 35 36 /** 37 * DOC: Calling mac80211 from interrupts 38 * 39 * Only ieee80211_tx_status_irqsafe() and ieee80211_rx_irqsafe() can be 40 * called in hardware interrupt context. The low-level driver must not call any 41 * other functions in hardware interrupt context. If there is a need for such 42 * call, the low-level driver should first ACK the interrupt and perform the 43 * IEEE 802.11 code call after this, e.g. from a scheduled workqueue or even 44 * tasklet function. 45 * 46 * NOTE: If the driver opts to use the _irqsafe() functions, it may not also 47 * use the non-IRQ-safe functions! 48 */ 49 50 /** 51 * DOC: Warning 52 * 53 * If you're reading this document and not the header file itself, it will 54 * be incomplete because not all documentation has been converted yet. 55 */ 56 57 /** 58 * DOC: Frame format 59 * 60 * As a general rule, when frames are passed between mac80211 and the driver, 61 * they start with the IEEE 802.11 header and include the same octets that are 62 * sent over the air except for the FCS which should be calculated by the 63 * hardware. 64 * 65 * There are, however, various exceptions to this rule for advanced features: 66 * 67 * The first exception is for hardware encryption and decryption offload 68 * where the IV/ICV may or may not be generated in hardware. 69 * 70 * Secondly, when the hardware handles fragmentation, the frame handed to 71 * the driver from mac80211 is the MSDU, not the MPDU. 72 */ 73 74 /** 75 * DOC: mac80211 workqueue 76 * 77 * mac80211 provides its own workqueue for drivers and internal mac80211 use. 78 * The workqueue is a single threaded workqueue and can only be accessed by 79 * helpers for sanity checking. Drivers must ensure all work added onto the 80 * mac80211 workqueue should be cancelled on the driver stop() callback. 81 * 82 * mac80211 will flushed the workqueue upon interface removal and during 83 * suspend. 84 * 85 * All work performed on the mac80211 workqueue must not acquire the RTNL lock. 86 * 87 */ 88 89 /** 90 * DOC: mac80211 software tx queueing 91 * 92 * mac80211 uses an intermediate queueing implementation, designed to allow the 93 * driver to keep hardware queues short and to provide some fairness between 94 * different stations/interfaces. 95 * 96 * Drivers must provide the .wake_tx_queue driver operation by either 97 * linking it to ieee80211_handle_wake_tx_queue() or implementing a custom 98 * handler. 99 * 100 * Intermediate queues (struct ieee80211_txq) are kept per-sta per-tid, with 101 * another per-sta for non-data/non-mgmt and bufferable management frames, and 102 * a single per-vif queue for multicast data frames. 103 * 104 * The driver is expected to initialize its private per-queue data for stations 105 * and interfaces in the .add_interface and .sta_add ops. 106 * 107 * The driver can't access the internal TX queues (iTXQs) directly. 108 * Whenever mac80211 adds a new frame to a queue, it calls the .wake_tx_queue 109 * driver op. 110 * Drivers implementing a custom .wake_tx_queue op can get them by calling 111 * ieee80211_tx_dequeue(). Drivers using ieee80211_handle_wake_tx_queue() will 112 * simply get the individual frames pushed via the .tx driver operation. 113 * 114 * Drivers can optionally delegate responsibility for scheduling queues to 115 * mac80211, to take advantage of airtime fairness accounting. In this case, to 116 * obtain the next queue to pull frames from, the driver calls 117 * ieee80211_next_txq(). The driver is then expected to return the txq using 118 * ieee80211_return_txq(). 119 * 120 * For AP powersave TIM handling, the driver only needs to indicate if it has 121 * buffered packets in the driver specific data structures by calling 122 * ieee80211_sta_set_buffered(). For frames buffered in the ieee80211_txq 123 * struct, mac80211 sets the appropriate TIM PVB bits and calls 124 * .release_buffered_frames(). 125 * In that callback the driver is therefore expected to release its own 126 * buffered frames and afterwards also frames from the ieee80211_txq (obtained 127 * via the usual ieee80211_tx_dequeue). 128 */ 129 130 /** 131 * DOC: HW timestamping 132 * 133 * Timing Measurement and Fine Timing Measurement require accurate timestamps 134 * of the action frames TX/RX and their respective acks. 135 * 136 * To report hardware timestamps for Timing Measurement or Fine Timing 137 * Measurement frame RX, the low level driver should set the SKB's hwtstamp 138 * field to the frame RX timestamp and report the ack TX timestamp in the 139 * ieee80211_rx_status struct. 140 * 141 * Similarly, To report hardware timestamps for Timing Measurement or Fine 142 * Timing Measurement frame TX, the driver should set the SKB's hwtstamp field 143 * to the frame TX timestamp and report the ack RX timestamp in the 144 * ieee80211_tx_status struct. 145 */ 146 struct device; 147 148 /** 149 * enum ieee80211_max_queues - maximum number of queues 150 * 151 * @IEEE80211_MAX_QUEUES: Maximum number of regular device queues. 152 * @IEEE80211_MAX_QUEUE_MAP: bitmap with maximum queues set 153 */ 154 enum ieee80211_max_queues { 155 IEEE80211_MAX_QUEUES = 16, 156 IEEE80211_MAX_QUEUE_MAP = BIT(IEEE80211_MAX_QUEUES) - 1, 157 }; 158 159 #define IEEE80211_INVAL_HW_QUEUE 0xff 160 161 /** 162 * enum ieee80211_ac_numbers - AC numbers as used in mac80211 163 * @IEEE80211_AC_VO: voice 164 * @IEEE80211_AC_VI: video 165 * @IEEE80211_AC_BE: best effort 166 * @IEEE80211_AC_BK: background 167 */ 168 enum ieee80211_ac_numbers { 169 IEEE80211_AC_VO = 0, 170 IEEE80211_AC_VI = 1, 171 IEEE80211_AC_BE = 2, 172 IEEE80211_AC_BK = 3, 173 }; 174 175 /** 176 * struct ieee80211_tx_queue_params - transmit queue configuration 177 * 178 * The information provided in this structure is required for QoS 179 * transmit queue configuration. Cf. IEEE 802.11 7.3.2.29. 180 * 181 * @aifs: arbitration interframe space [0..255] 182 * @cw_min: minimum contention window [a value of the form 183 * 2^n-1 in the range 1..32767] 184 * @cw_max: maximum contention window [like @cw_min] 185 * @txop: maximum burst time in units of 32 usecs, 0 meaning disabled 186 * @acm: is mandatory admission control required for the access category 187 * @uapsd: is U-APSD mode enabled for the queue 188 * @mu_edca: is the MU EDCA configured 189 * @mu_edca_param_rec: MU EDCA Parameter Record for HE 190 */ 191 struct ieee80211_tx_queue_params { 192 u16 txop; 193 u16 cw_min; 194 u16 cw_max; 195 u8 aifs; 196 bool acm; 197 bool uapsd; 198 bool mu_edca; 199 struct ieee80211_he_mu_edca_param_ac_rec mu_edca_param_rec; 200 }; 201 202 struct ieee80211_low_level_stats { 203 unsigned int dot11ACKFailureCount; 204 unsigned int dot11RTSFailureCount; 205 unsigned int dot11FCSErrorCount; 206 unsigned int dot11RTSSuccessCount; 207 }; 208 209 /** 210 * enum ieee80211_chanctx_change - change flag for channel context 211 * @IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_WIDTH: The channel width changed 212 * @IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_RX_CHAINS: The number of RX chains changed 213 * @IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_RADAR: radar detection flag changed 214 * @IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_CHANNEL: switched to another operating channel, 215 * this is used only with channel switching with CSA 216 * @IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_MIN_WIDTH: The min required channel width changed 217 */ 218 enum ieee80211_chanctx_change { 219 IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_WIDTH = BIT(0), 220 IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_RX_CHAINS = BIT(1), 221 IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_RADAR = BIT(2), 222 IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_CHANNEL = BIT(3), 223 IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_MIN_WIDTH = BIT(4), 224 }; 225 226 /** 227 * struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf - channel context that vifs may be tuned to 228 * 229 * This is the driver-visible part. The ieee80211_chanctx 230 * that contains it is visible in mac80211 only. 231 * 232 * @def: the channel definition 233 * @min_def: the minimum channel definition currently required. 234 * @rx_chains_static: The number of RX chains that must always be 235 * active on the channel to receive MIMO transmissions 236 * @rx_chains_dynamic: The number of RX chains that must be enabled 237 * after RTS/CTS handshake to receive SMPS MIMO transmissions; 238 * this will always be >= @rx_chains_static. 239 * @radar_enabled: whether radar detection is enabled on this channel. 240 * @drv_priv: data area for driver use, will always be aligned to 241 * sizeof(void *), size is determined in hw information. 242 */ 243 struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf { 244 struct cfg80211_chan_def def; 245 struct cfg80211_chan_def min_def; 246 247 u8 rx_chains_static, rx_chains_dynamic; 248 249 bool radar_enabled; 250 251 u8 drv_priv[] __aligned(sizeof(void *)); 252 }; 253 254 /** 255 * enum ieee80211_chanctx_switch_mode - channel context switch mode 256 * @CHANCTX_SWMODE_REASSIGN_VIF: Both old and new contexts already 257 * exist (and will continue to exist), but the virtual interface 258 * needs to be switched from one to the other. 259 * @CHANCTX_SWMODE_SWAP_CONTEXTS: The old context exists but will stop 260 * to exist with this call, the new context doesn't exist but 261 * will be active after this call, the virtual interface switches 262 * from the old to the new (note that the driver may of course 263 * implement this as an on-the-fly chandef switch of the existing 264 * hardware context, but the mac80211 pointer for the old context 265 * will cease to exist and only the new one will later be used 266 * for changes/removal.) 267 */ 268 enum ieee80211_chanctx_switch_mode { 269 CHANCTX_SWMODE_REASSIGN_VIF, 270 CHANCTX_SWMODE_SWAP_CONTEXTS, 271 }; 272 273 /** 274 * struct ieee80211_vif_chanctx_switch - vif chanctx switch information 275 * 276 * This is structure is used to pass information about a vif that 277 * needs to switch from one chanctx to another. The 278 * &ieee80211_chanctx_switch_mode defines how the switch should be 279 * done. 280 * 281 * @vif: the vif that should be switched from old_ctx to new_ctx 282 * @link_conf: the link conf that's switching 283 * @old_ctx: the old context to which the vif was assigned 284 * @new_ctx: the new context to which the vif must be assigned 285 */ 286 struct ieee80211_vif_chanctx_switch { 287 struct ieee80211_vif *vif; 288 struct ieee80211_bss_conf *link_conf; 289 struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *old_ctx; 290 struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *new_ctx; 291 }; 292 293 /** 294 * enum ieee80211_bss_change - BSS change notification flags 295 * 296 * These flags are used with the bss_info_changed(), link_info_changed() 297 * and vif_cfg_changed() callbacks to indicate which parameter(s) changed. 298 * 299 * @BSS_CHANGED_ASSOC: association status changed (associated/disassociated), 300 * also implies a change in the AID. 301 * @BSS_CHANGED_ERP_CTS_PROT: CTS protection changed 302 * @BSS_CHANGED_ERP_PREAMBLE: preamble changed 303 * @BSS_CHANGED_ERP_SLOT: slot timing changed 304 * @BSS_CHANGED_HT: 802.11n parameters changed 305 * @BSS_CHANGED_BASIC_RATES: Basic rateset changed 306 * @BSS_CHANGED_BEACON_INT: Beacon interval changed 307 * @BSS_CHANGED_BSSID: BSSID changed, for whatever 308 * reason (IBSS and managed mode) 309 * @BSS_CHANGED_BEACON: Beacon data changed, retrieve 310 * new beacon (beaconing modes) 311 * @BSS_CHANGED_BEACON_ENABLED: Beaconing should be 312 * enabled/disabled (beaconing modes) 313 * @BSS_CHANGED_CQM: Connection quality monitor config changed 314 * @BSS_CHANGED_IBSS: IBSS join status changed 315 * @BSS_CHANGED_ARP_FILTER: Hardware ARP filter address list or state changed. 316 * @BSS_CHANGED_QOS: QoS for this association was enabled/disabled. Note 317 * that it is only ever disabled for station mode. 318 * @BSS_CHANGED_IDLE: Idle changed for this BSS/interface. 319 * @BSS_CHANGED_SSID: SSID changed for this BSS (AP and IBSS mode) 320 * @BSS_CHANGED_AP_PROBE_RESP: Probe Response changed for this BSS (AP mode) 321 * @BSS_CHANGED_PS: PS changed for this BSS (STA mode) 322 * @BSS_CHANGED_TXPOWER: TX power setting changed for this interface 323 * @BSS_CHANGED_P2P_PS: P2P powersave settings (CTWindow, opportunistic PS) 324 * changed 325 * @BSS_CHANGED_BEACON_INFO: Data from the AP's beacon became available: 326 * currently dtim_period only is under consideration. 327 * @BSS_CHANGED_BANDWIDTH: The bandwidth used by this interface changed, 328 * note that this is only called when it changes after the channel 329 * context had been assigned. 330 * @BSS_CHANGED_OCB: OCB join status changed 331 * @BSS_CHANGED_MU_GROUPS: VHT MU-MIMO group id or user position changed 332 * @BSS_CHANGED_KEEP_ALIVE: keep alive options (idle period or protected 333 * keep alive) changed. 334 * @BSS_CHANGED_MCAST_RATE: Multicast Rate setting changed for this interface 335 * @BSS_CHANGED_FTM_RESPONDER: fine timing measurement request responder 336 * functionality changed for this BSS (AP mode). 337 * @BSS_CHANGED_TWT: TWT status changed 338 * @BSS_CHANGED_HE_OBSS_PD: OBSS Packet Detection status changed. 339 * @BSS_CHANGED_HE_BSS_COLOR: BSS Color has changed 340 * @BSS_CHANGED_FILS_DISCOVERY: FILS discovery status changed. 341 * @BSS_CHANGED_UNSOL_BCAST_PROBE_RESP: Unsolicited broadcast probe response 342 * status changed. 343 * @BSS_CHANGED_EHT_PUNCTURING: The channel puncturing bitmap changed. 344 */ 345 enum ieee80211_bss_change { 346 BSS_CHANGED_ASSOC = 1<<0, 347 BSS_CHANGED_ERP_CTS_PROT = 1<<1, 348 BSS_CHANGED_ERP_PREAMBLE = 1<<2, 349 BSS_CHANGED_ERP_SLOT = 1<<3, 350 BSS_CHANGED_HT = 1<<4, 351 BSS_CHANGED_BASIC_RATES = 1<<5, 352 BSS_CHANGED_BEACON_INT = 1<<6, 353 BSS_CHANGED_BSSID = 1<<7, 354 BSS_CHANGED_BEACON = 1<<8, 355 BSS_CHANGED_BEACON_ENABLED = 1<<9, 356 BSS_CHANGED_CQM = 1<<10, 357 BSS_CHANGED_IBSS = 1<<11, 358 BSS_CHANGED_ARP_FILTER = 1<<12, 359 BSS_CHANGED_QOS = 1<<13, 360 BSS_CHANGED_IDLE = 1<<14, 361 BSS_CHANGED_SSID = 1<<15, 362 BSS_CHANGED_AP_PROBE_RESP = 1<<16, 363 BSS_CHANGED_PS = 1<<17, 364 BSS_CHANGED_TXPOWER = 1<<18, 365 BSS_CHANGED_P2P_PS = 1<<19, 366 BSS_CHANGED_BEACON_INFO = 1<<20, 367 BSS_CHANGED_BANDWIDTH = 1<<21, 368 BSS_CHANGED_OCB = 1<<22, 369 BSS_CHANGED_MU_GROUPS = 1<<23, 370 BSS_CHANGED_KEEP_ALIVE = 1<<24, 371 BSS_CHANGED_MCAST_RATE = 1<<25, 372 BSS_CHANGED_FTM_RESPONDER = 1<<26, 373 BSS_CHANGED_TWT = 1<<27, 374 BSS_CHANGED_HE_OBSS_PD = 1<<28, 375 BSS_CHANGED_HE_BSS_COLOR = 1<<29, 376 BSS_CHANGED_FILS_DISCOVERY = 1<<30, 377 BSS_CHANGED_UNSOL_BCAST_PROBE_RESP = 1<<31, 378 BSS_CHANGED_EHT_PUNCTURING = BIT_ULL(32), 379 380 /* when adding here, make sure to change ieee80211_reconfig */ 381 }; 382 383 /* 384 * The maximum number of IPv4 addresses listed for ARP filtering. If the number 385 * of addresses for an interface increase beyond this value, hardware ARP 386 * filtering will be disabled. 387 */ 388 #define IEEE80211_BSS_ARP_ADDR_LIST_LEN 4 389 390 /** 391 * enum ieee80211_event_type - event to be notified to the low level driver 392 * @RSSI_EVENT: AP's rssi crossed the a threshold set by the driver. 393 * @MLME_EVENT: event related to MLME 394 * @BAR_RX_EVENT: a BAR was received 395 * @BA_FRAME_TIMEOUT: Frames were released from the reordering buffer because 396 * they timed out. This won't be called for each frame released, but only 397 * once each time the timeout triggers. 398 */ 399 enum ieee80211_event_type { 400 RSSI_EVENT, 401 MLME_EVENT, 402 BAR_RX_EVENT, 403 BA_FRAME_TIMEOUT, 404 }; 405 406 /** 407 * enum ieee80211_rssi_event_data - relevant when event type is %RSSI_EVENT 408 * @RSSI_EVENT_HIGH: AP's rssi went below the threshold set by the driver. 409 * @RSSI_EVENT_LOW: AP's rssi went above the threshold set by the driver. 410 */ 411 enum ieee80211_rssi_event_data { 412 RSSI_EVENT_HIGH, 413 RSSI_EVENT_LOW, 414 }; 415 416 /** 417 * struct ieee80211_rssi_event - data attached to an %RSSI_EVENT 418 * @data: See &enum ieee80211_rssi_event_data 419 */ 420 struct ieee80211_rssi_event { 421 enum ieee80211_rssi_event_data data; 422 }; 423 424 /** 425 * enum ieee80211_mlme_event_data - relevant when event type is %MLME_EVENT 426 * @AUTH_EVENT: the MLME operation is authentication 427 * @ASSOC_EVENT: the MLME operation is association 428 * @DEAUTH_RX_EVENT: deauth received.. 429 * @DEAUTH_TX_EVENT: deauth sent. 430 */ 431 enum ieee80211_mlme_event_data { 432 AUTH_EVENT, 433 ASSOC_EVENT, 434 DEAUTH_RX_EVENT, 435 DEAUTH_TX_EVENT, 436 }; 437 438 /** 439 * enum ieee80211_mlme_event_status - relevant when event type is %MLME_EVENT 440 * @MLME_SUCCESS: the MLME operation completed successfully. 441 * @MLME_DENIED: the MLME operation was denied by the peer. 442 * @MLME_TIMEOUT: the MLME operation timed out. 443 */ 444 enum ieee80211_mlme_event_status { 445 MLME_SUCCESS, 446 MLME_DENIED, 447 MLME_TIMEOUT, 448 }; 449 450 /** 451 * struct ieee80211_mlme_event - data attached to an %MLME_EVENT 452 * @data: See &enum ieee80211_mlme_event_data 453 * @status: See &enum ieee80211_mlme_event_status 454 * @reason: the reason code if applicable 455 */ 456 struct ieee80211_mlme_event { 457 enum ieee80211_mlme_event_data data; 458 enum ieee80211_mlme_event_status status; 459 u16 reason; 460 }; 461 462 /** 463 * struct ieee80211_ba_event - data attached for BlockAck related events 464 * @sta: pointer to the &ieee80211_sta to which this event relates 465 * @tid: the tid 466 * @ssn: the starting sequence number (for %BAR_RX_EVENT) 467 */ 468 struct ieee80211_ba_event { 469 struct ieee80211_sta *sta; 470 u16 tid; 471 u16 ssn; 472 }; 473 474 /** 475 * struct ieee80211_event - event to be sent to the driver 476 * @type: The event itself. See &enum ieee80211_event_type. 477 * @rssi: relevant if &type is %RSSI_EVENT 478 * @mlme: relevant if &type is %AUTH_EVENT 479 * @ba: relevant if &type is %BAR_RX_EVENT or %BA_FRAME_TIMEOUT 480 * @u:union holding the fields above 481 */ 482 struct ieee80211_event { 483 enum ieee80211_event_type type; 484 union { 485 struct ieee80211_rssi_event rssi; 486 struct ieee80211_mlme_event mlme; 487 struct ieee80211_ba_event ba; 488 } u; 489 }; 490 491 /** 492 * struct ieee80211_mu_group_data - STA's VHT MU-MIMO group data 493 * 494 * This structure describes the group id data of VHT MU-MIMO 495 * 496 * @membership: 64 bits array - a bit is set if station is member of the group 497 * @position: 2 bits per group id indicating the position in the group 498 */ 499 struct ieee80211_mu_group_data { 500 u8 membership[WLAN_MEMBERSHIP_LEN]; 501 u8 position[WLAN_USER_POSITION_LEN]; 502 }; 503 504 /** 505 * struct ieee80211_ftm_responder_params - FTM responder parameters 506 * 507 * @lci: LCI subelement content 508 * @civicloc: CIVIC location subelement content 509 * @lci_len: LCI data length 510 * @civicloc_len: Civic data length 511 */ 512 struct ieee80211_ftm_responder_params { 513 const u8 *lci; 514 const u8 *civicloc; 515 size_t lci_len; 516 size_t civicloc_len; 517 }; 518 519 /** 520 * struct ieee80211_fils_discovery - FILS discovery parameters from 521 * IEEE Std 802.11ai-2016, Annex C.3 MIB detail. 522 * 523 * @min_interval: Minimum packet interval in TUs (0 - 10000) 524 * @max_interval: Maximum packet interval in TUs (0 - 10000) 525 */ 526 struct ieee80211_fils_discovery { 527 u32 min_interval; 528 u32 max_interval; 529 }; 530 531 /** 532 * struct ieee80211_bss_conf - holds the BSS's changing parameters 533 * 534 * This structure keeps information about a BSS (and an association 535 * to that BSS) that can change during the lifetime of the BSS. 536 * 537 * @vif: reference to owning VIF 538 * @addr: (link) address used locally 539 * @link_id: link ID, or 0 for non-MLO 540 * @htc_trig_based_pkt_ext: default PE in 4us units, if BSS supports HE 541 * @uora_exists: is the UORA element advertised by AP 542 * @ack_enabled: indicates support to receive a multi-TID that solicits either 543 * ACK, BACK or both 544 * @uora_ocw_range: UORA element's OCW Range field 545 * @frame_time_rts_th: HE duration RTS threshold, in units of 32us 546 * @he_support: does this BSS support HE 547 * @twt_requester: does this BSS support TWT requester (relevant for managed 548 * mode only, set if the AP advertises TWT responder role) 549 * @twt_responder: does this BSS support TWT requester (relevant for managed 550 * mode only, set if the AP advertises TWT responder role) 551 * @twt_protected: does this BSS support protected TWT frames 552 * @twt_broadcast: does this BSS support broadcast TWT 553 * @use_cts_prot: use CTS protection 554 * @use_short_preamble: use 802.11b short preamble 555 * @use_short_slot: use short slot time (only relevant for ERP) 556 * @dtim_period: num of beacons before the next DTIM, for beaconing, 557 * valid in station mode only if after the driver was notified 558 * with the %BSS_CHANGED_BEACON_INFO flag, will be non-zero then. 559 * @sync_tsf: last beacon's/probe response's TSF timestamp (could be old 560 * as it may have been received during scanning long ago). If the 561 * HW flag %IEEE80211_HW_TIMING_BEACON_ONLY is set, then this can 562 * only come from a beacon, but might not become valid until after 563 * association when a beacon is received (which is notified with the 564 * %BSS_CHANGED_DTIM flag.). See also sync_dtim_count important notice. 565 * @sync_device_ts: the device timestamp corresponding to the sync_tsf, 566 * the driver/device can use this to calculate synchronisation 567 * (see @sync_tsf). See also sync_dtim_count important notice. 568 * @sync_dtim_count: Only valid when %IEEE80211_HW_TIMING_BEACON_ONLY 569 * is requested, see @sync_tsf/@sync_device_ts. 570 * IMPORTANT: These three sync_* parameters would possibly be out of sync 571 * by the time the driver will use them. The synchronized view is currently 572 * guaranteed only in certain callbacks. 573 * Note also that this is not used with MLD associations, mac80211 doesn't 574 * know how to track beacons for all of the links for this. 575 * @beacon_int: beacon interval 576 * @assoc_capability: capabilities taken from assoc resp 577 * @basic_rates: bitmap of basic rates, each bit stands for an 578 * index into the rate table configured by the driver in 579 * the current band. 580 * @beacon_rate: associated AP's beacon TX rate 581 * @mcast_rate: per-band multicast rate index + 1 (0: disabled) 582 * @bssid: The BSSID for this BSS 583 * @enable_beacon: whether beaconing should be enabled or not 584 * @chandef: Channel definition for this BSS -- the hardware might be 585 * configured a higher bandwidth than this BSS uses, for example. 586 * @mu_group: VHT MU-MIMO group membership data 587 * @ht_operation_mode: HT operation mode like in &struct ieee80211_ht_operation. 588 * This field is only valid when the channel is a wide HT/VHT channel. 589 * Note that with TDLS this can be the case (channel is HT, protection must 590 * be used from this field) even when the BSS association isn't using HT. 591 * @cqm_rssi_thold: Connection quality monitor RSSI threshold, a zero value 592 * implies disabled. As with the cfg80211 callback, a change here should 593 * cause an event to be sent indicating where the current value is in 594 * relation to the newly configured threshold. 595 * @cqm_rssi_low: Connection quality monitor RSSI lower threshold, a zero value 596 * implies disabled. This is an alternative mechanism to the single 597 * threshold event and can't be enabled simultaneously with it. 598 * @cqm_rssi_high: Connection quality monitor RSSI upper threshold. 599 * @cqm_rssi_hyst: Connection quality monitor RSSI hysteresis 600 * @qos: This is a QoS-enabled BSS. 601 * @hidden_ssid: The SSID of the current vif is hidden. Only valid in AP-mode. 602 * @txpower: TX power in dBm. INT_MIN means not configured. 603 * @txpower_type: TX power adjustment used to control per packet Transmit 604 * Power Control (TPC) in lower driver for the current vif. In particular 605 * TPC is enabled if value passed in %txpower_type is 606 * NL80211_TX_POWER_LIMITED (allow using less than specified from 607 * userspace), whereas TPC is disabled if %txpower_type is set to 608 * NL80211_TX_POWER_FIXED (use value configured from userspace) 609 * @p2p_noa_attr: P2P NoA attribute for P2P powersave 610 * @allow_p2p_go_ps: indication for AP or P2P GO interface, whether it's allowed 611 * to use P2P PS mechanism or not. AP/P2P GO is not allowed to use P2P PS 612 * if it has associated clients without P2P PS support. 613 * @max_idle_period: the time period during which the station can refrain from 614 * transmitting frames to its associated AP without being disassociated. 615 * In units of 1000 TUs. Zero value indicates that the AP did not include 616 * a (valid) BSS Max Idle Period Element. 617 * @protected_keep_alive: if set, indicates that the station should send an RSN 618 * protected frame to the AP to reset the idle timer at the AP for the 619 * station. 620 * @ftm_responder: whether to enable or disable fine timing measurement FTM 621 * responder functionality. 622 * @ftmr_params: configurable lci/civic parameter when enabling FTM responder. 623 * @nontransmitted: this BSS is a nontransmitted BSS profile 624 * @transmitter_bssid: the address of transmitter AP 625 * @bssid_index: index inside the multiple BSSID set 626 * @bssid_indicator: 2^bssid_indicator is the maximum number of APs in set 627 * @ema_ap: AP supports enhancements of discovery and advertisement of 628 * nontransmitted BSSIDs 629 * @profile_periodicity: the least number of beacon frames need to be received 630 * in order to discover all the nontransmitted BSSIDs in the set. 631 * @he_oper: HE operation information of the BSS (AP/Mesh) or of the AP we are 632 * connected to (STA) 633 * @he_obss_pd: OBSS Packet Detection parameters. 634 * @he_bss_color: BSS coloring settings, if BSS supports HE 635 * @fils_discovery: FILS discovery configuration 636 * @unsol_bcast_probe_resp_interval: Unsolicited broadcast probe response 637 * interval. 638 * @beacon_tx_rate: The configured beacon transmit rate that needs to be passed 639 * to driver when rate control is offloaded to firmware. 640 * @power_type: power type of BSS for 6 GHz 641 * @tx_pwr_env: transmit power envelope array of BSS. 642 * @tx_pwr_env_num: number of @tx_pwr_env. 643 * @pwr_reduction: power constraint of BSS. 644 * @eht_support: does this BSS support EHT 645 * @eht_puncturing: bitmap to indicate which channels are punctured in this BSS 646 * @csa_active: marks whether a channel switch is going on. Internally it is 647 * write-protected by sdata_lock and local->mtx so holding either is fine 648 * for read access. 649 * @csa_punct_bitmap: new puncturing bitmap for channel switch 650 * @mu_mimo_owner: indicates interface owns MU-MIMO capability 651 * @chanctx_conf: The channel context this interface is assigned to, or %NULL 652 * when it is not assigned. This pointer is RCU-protected due to the TX 653 * path needing to access it; even though the netdev carrier will always 654 * be off when it is %NULL there can still be races and packets could be 655 * processed after it switches back to %NULL. 656 * @color_change_active: marks whether a color change is ongoing. Internally it is 657 * write-protected by sdata_lock and local->mtx so holding either is fine 658 * for read access. 659 * @color_change_color: the bss color that will be used after the change. 660 * @ht_ldpc: in AP mode, indicates interface has HT LDPC capability. 661 * @vht_ldpc: in AP mode, indicates interface has VHT LDPC capability. 662 * @he_ldpc: in AP mode, indicates interface has HE LDPC capability. 663 * @vht_su_beamformer: in AP mode, does this BSS support operation as an VHT SU 664 * beamformer 665 * @vht_su_beamformee: in AP mode, does this BSS support operation as an VHT SU 666 * beamformee 667 * @vht_mu_beamformer: in AP mode, does this BSS support operation as an VHT MU 668 * beamformer 669 * @vht_mu_beamformee: in AP mode, does this BSS support operation as an VHT MU 670 * beamformee 671 * @he_su_beamformer: in AP-mode, does this BSS support operation as an HE SU 672 * beamformer 673 * @he_su_beamformee: in AP-mode, does this BSS support operation as an HE SU 674 * beamformee 675 * @he_mu_beamformer: in AP-mode, does this BSS support operation as an HE MU 676 * beamformer 677 * @he_full_ul_mumimo: does this BSS support the reception (AP) or transmission 678 * (non-AP STA) of an HE TB PPDU on an RU that spans the entire PPDU 679 * bandwidth 680 * @eht_su_beamformer: in AP-mode, does this BSS enable operation as an EHT SU 681 * beamformer 682 * @eht_su_beamformee: in AP-mode, does this BSS enable operation as an EHT SU 683 * beamformee 684 * @eht_mu_beamformer: in AP-mode, does this BSS enable operation as an EHT MU 685 * beamformer 686 */ 687 struct ieee80211_bss_conf { 688 struct ieee80211_vif *vif; 689 690 const u8 *bssid; 691 unsigned int link_id; 692 u8 addr[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2); 693 u8 htc_trig_based_pkt_ext; 694 bool uora_exists; 695 u8 uora_ocw_range; 696 u16 frame_time_rts_th; 697 bool he_support; 698 bool twt_requester; 699 bool twt_responder; 700 bool twt_protected; 701 bool twt_broadcast; 702 /* erp related data */ 703 bool use_cts_prot; 704 bool use_short_preamble; 705 bool use_short_slot; 706 bool enable_beacon; 707 u8 dtim_period; 708 u16 beacon_int; 709 u16 assoc_capability; 710 u64 sync_tsf; 711 u32 sync_device_ts; 712 u8 sync_dtim_count; 713 u32 basic_rates; 714 struct ieee80211_rate *beacon_rate; 715 int mcast_rate[NUM_NL80211_BANDS]; 716 u16 ht_operation_mode; 717 s32 cqm_rssi_thold; 718 u32 cqm_rssi_hyst; 719 s32 cqm_rssi_low; 720 s32 cqm_rssi_high; 721 struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef; 722 struct ieee80211_mu_group_data mu_group; 723 bool qos; 724 bool hidden_ssid; 725 int txpower; 726 enum nl80211_tx_power_setting txpower_type; 727 struct ieee80211_p2p_noa_attr p2p_noa_attr; 728 bool allow_p2p_go_ps; 729 u16 max_idle_period; 730 bool protected_keep_alive; 731 bool ftm_responder; 732 struct ieee80211_ftm_responder_params *ftmr_params; 733 /* Multiple BSSID data */ 734 bool nontransmitted; 735 u8 transmitter_bssid[ETH_ALEN]; 736 u8 bssid_index; 737 u8 bssid_indicator; 738 bool ema_ap; 739 u8 profile_periodicity; 740 struct { 741 u32 params; 742 u16 nss_set; 743 } he_oper; 744 struct ieee80211_he_obss_pd he_obss_pd; 745 struct cfg80211_he_bss_color he_bss_color; 746 struct ieee80211_fils_discovery fils_discovery; 747 u32 unsol_bcast_probe_resp_interval; 748 struct cfg80211_bitrate_mask beacon_tx_rate; 749 enum ieee80211_ap_reg_power power_type; 750 struct ieee80211_tx_pwr_env tx_pwr_env[IEEE80211_TPE_MAX_IE_COUNT]; 751 u8 tx_pwr_env_num; 752 u8 pwr_reduction; 753 bool eht_support; 754 u16 eht_puncturing; 755 756 bool csa_active; 757 u16 csa_punct_bitmap; 758 759 bool mu_mimo_owner; 760 struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf __rcu *chanctx_conf; 761 762 bool color_change_active; 763 u8 color_change_color; 764 765 bool ht_ldpc; 766 bool vht_ldpc; 767 bool he_ldpc; 768 bool vht_su_beamformer; 769 bool vht_su_beamformee; 770 bool vht_mu_beamformer; 771 bool vht_mu_beamformee; 772 bool he_su_beamformer; 773 bool he_su_beamformee; 774 bool he_mu_beamformer; 775 bool he_full_ul_mumimo; 776 bool eht_su_beamformer; 777 bool eht_su_beamformee; 778 bool eht_mu_beamformer; 779 }; 780 781 /** 782 * enum mac80211_tx_info_flags - flags to describe transmission information/status 783 * 784 * These flags are used with the @flags member of &ieee80211_tx_info. 785 * 786 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_REQ_TX_STATUS: require TX status callback for this frame. 787 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_ASSIGN_SEQ: The driver has to assign a sequence 788 * number to this frame, taking care of not overwriting the fragment 789 * number and increasing the sequence number only when the 790 * IEEE80211_TX_CTL_FIRST_FRAGMENT flag is set. mac80211 will properly 791 * assign sequence numbers to QoS-data frames but cannot do so correctly 792 * for non-QoS-data and management frames because beacons need them from 793 * that counter as well and mac80211 cannot guarantee proper sequencing. 794 * If this flag is set, the driver should instruct the hardware to 795 * assign a sequence number to the frame or assign one itself. Cf. IEEE 796 * 802.11-2007 7.1.3.4.1 paragraph 3. This flag will always be set for 797 * beacons and always be clear for frames without a sequence number field. 798 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_ACK: tell the low level not to wait for an ack 799 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_CLEAR_PS_FILT: clear powersave filter for destination 800 * station 801 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_FIRST_FRAGMENT: this is a first fragment of the frame 802 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_SEND_AFTER_DTIM: send this frame after DTIM beacon 803 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_AMPDU: this frame should be sent as part of an A-MPDU 804 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_INJECTED: Frame was injected, internal to mac80211. 805 * @IEEE80211_TX_STAT_TX_FILTERED: The frame was not transmitted 806 * because the destination STA was in powersave mode. Note that to 807 * avoid race conditions, the filter must be set by the hardware or 808 * firmware upon receiving a frame that indicates that the station 809 * went to sleep (must be done on device to filter frames already on 810 * the queue) and may only be unset after mac80211 gives the OK for 811 * that by setting the IEEE80211_TX_CTL_CLEAR_PS_FILT (see above), 812 * since only then is it guaranteed that no more frames are in the 813 * hardware queue. 814 * @IEEE80211_TX_STAT_ACK: Frame was acknowledged 815 * @IEEE80211_TX_STAT_AMPDU: The frame was aggregated, so status 816 * is for the whole aggregation. 817 * @IEEE80211_TX_STAT_AMPDU_NO_BACK: no block ack was returned, 818 * so consider using block ack request (BAR). 819 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_RATE_CTRL_PROBE: internal to mac80211, can be 820 * set by rate control algorithms to indicate probe rate, will 821 * be cleared for fragmented frames (except on the last fragment) 822 * @IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_OFFCHAN_TX_OK: Internal to mac80211. Used to indicate 823 * that a frame can be transmitted while the queues are stopped for 824 * off-channel operation. 825 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_HW_80211_ENCAP: This frame uses hardware encapsulation 826 * (header conversion) 827 * @IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_RETRIED: completely internal to mac80211, 828 * used to indicate that a frame was already retried due to PS 829 * @IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_DONT_ENCRYPT: completely internal to mac80211, 830 * used to indicate frame should not be encrypted 831 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_PS_BUFFER: This frame is a response to a poll 832 * frame (PS-Poll or uAPSD) or a non-bufferable MMPDU and must 833 * be sent although the station is in powersave mode. 834 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_MORE_FRAMES: More frames will be passed to the 835 * transmit function after the current frame, this can be used 836 * by drivers to kick the DMA queue only if unset or when the 837 * queue gets full. 838 * @IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_RETRANSMISSION: This frame is being retransmitted 839 * after TX status because the destination was asleep, it must not 840 * be modified again (no seqno assignment, crypto, etc.) 841 * @IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_MLME_CONN_TX: This frame was transmitted by the MLME 842 * code for connection establishment, this indicates that its status 843 * should kick the MLME state machine. 844 * @IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_NL80211_FRAME_TX: Frame was requested through nl80211 845 * MLME command (internal to mac80211 to figure out whether to send TX 846 * status to user space) 847 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_LDPC: tells the driver to use LDPC for this frame 848 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_STBC: Enables Space-Time Block Coding (STBC) for this 849 * frame and selects the maximum number of streams that it can use. 850 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_TX_OFFCHAN: Marks this packet to be transmitted on 851 * the off-channel channel when a remain-on-channel offload is done 852 * in hardware -- normal packets still flow and are expected to be 853 * handled properly by the device. 854 * @IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_TKIP_MIC_FAILURE: Marks this packet to be used for TKIP 855 * testing. It will be sent out with incorrect Michael MIC key to allow 856 * TKIP countermeasures to be tested. 857 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_CCK_RATE: This frame will be sent at non CCK rate. 858 * This flag is actually used for management frame especially for P2P 859 * frames not being sent at CCK rate in 2GHz band. 860 * @IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP: This packet marks the end of service period, 861 * when its status is reported the service period ends. For frames in 862 * an SP that mac80211 transmits, it is already set; for driver frames 863 * the driver may set this flag. It is also used to do the same for 864 * PS-Poll responses. 865 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_USE_MINRATE: This frame will be sent at lowest rate. 866 * This flag is used to send nullfunc frame at minimum rate when 867 * the nullfunc is used for connection monitoring purpose. 868 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_DONTFRAG: Don't fragment this packet even if it 869 * would be fragmented by size (this is optional, only used for 870 * monitor injection). 871 * @IEEE80211_TX_STAT_NOACK_TRANSMITTED: A frame that was marked with 872 * IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_ACK has been successfully transmitted without 873 * any errors (like issues specific to the driver/HW). 874 * This flag must not be set for frames that don't request no-ack 875 * behaviour with IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_ACK. 876 * 877 * Note: If you have to add new flags to the enumeration, then don't 878 * forget to update %IEEE80211_TX_TEMPORARY_FLAGS when necessary. 879 */ 880 enum mac80211_tx_info_flags { 881 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_REQ_TX_STATUS = BIT(0), 882 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_ASSIGN_SEQ = BIT(1), 883 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_ACK = BIT(2), 884 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_CLEAR_PS_FILT = BIT(3), 885 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_FIRST_FRAGMENT = BIT(4), 886 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_SEND_AFTER_DTIM = BIT(5), 887 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_AMPDU = BIT(6), 888 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_INJECTED = BIT(7), 889 IEEE80211_TX_STAT_TX_FILTERED = BIT(8), 890 IEEE80211_TX_STAT_ACK = BIT(9), 891 IEEE80211_TX_STAT_AMPDU = BIT(10), 892 IEEE80211_TX_STAT_AMPDU_NO_BACK = BIT(11), 893 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_RATE_CTRL_PROBE = BIT(12), 894 IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_OFFCHAN_TX_OK = BIT(13), 895 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_HW_80211_ENCAP = BIT(14), 896 IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_RETRIED = BIT(15), 897 IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_DONT_ENCRYPT = BIT(16), 898 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_PS_BUFFER = BIT(17), 899 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_MORE_FRAMES = BIT(18), 900 IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_RETRANSMISSION = BIT(19), 901 IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_MLME_CONN_TX = BIT(20), 902 IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_NL80211_FRAME_TX = BIT(21), 903 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_LDPC = BIT(22), 904 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_STBC = BIT(23) | BIT(24), 905 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_TX_OFFCHAN = BIT(25), 906 IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_TKIP_MIC_FAILURE = BIT(26), 907 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_CCK_RATE = BIT(27), 908 IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP = BIT(28), 909 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_USE_MINRATE = BIT(29), 910 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_DONTFRAG = BIT(30), 911 IEEE80211_TX_STAT_NOACK_TRANSMITTED = BIT(31), 912 }; 913 914 #define IEEE80211_TX_CTL_STBC_SHIFT 23 915 916 #define IEEE80211_TX_RC_S1G_MCS IEEE80211_TX_RC_VHT_MCS 917 918 /** 919 * enum mac80211_tx_control_flags - flags to describe transmit control 920 * 921 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_PORT_CTRL_PROTO: this frame is a port control 922 * protocol frame (e.g. EAP) 923 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_PS_RESPONSE: This frame is a response to a poll 924 * frame (PS-Poll or uAPSD). 925 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_RATE_INJECT: This frame is injected with rate information 926 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_AMSDU: This frame is an A-MSDU frame 927 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_FAST_XMIT: This frame is going through the fast_xmit path 928 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_SKIP_MPATH_LOOKUP: This frame skips mesh path lookup 929 * @IEEE80211_TX_INTCFL_NEED_TXPROCESSING: completely internal to mac80211, 930 * used to indicate that a pending frame requires TX processing before 931 * it can be sent out. 932 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_NO_SEQNO: Do not overwrite the sequence number that 933 * has already been assigned to this frame. 934 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_DONT_REORDER: This frame should not be reordered 935 * relative to other frames that have this flag set, independent 936 * of their QoS TID or other priority field values. 937 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_MCAST_MLO_FIRST_TX: first MLO TX, used mostly internally 938 * for sequence number assignment 939 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_MLO_LINK: If not @IEEE80211_LINK_UNSPECIFIED, this 940 * frame should be transmitted on the specific link. This really is 941 * only relevant for frames that do not have data present, and is 942 * also not used for 802.3 format frames. Note that even if the frame 943 * is on a specific link, address translation might still apply if 944 * it's intended for an MLD. 945 * 946 * These flags are used in tx_info->control.flags. 947 */ 948 enum mac80211_tx_control_flags { 949 IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_PORT_CTRL_PROTO = BIT(0), 950 IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_PS_RESPONSE = BIT(1), 951 IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_RATE_INJECT = BIT(2), 952 IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_AMSDU = BIT(3), 953 IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_FAST_XMIT = BIT(4), 954 IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_SKIP_MPATH_LOOKUP = BIT(5), 955 IEEE80211_TX_INTCFL_NEED_TXPROCESSING = BIT(6), 956 IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_NO_SEQNO = BIT(7), 957 IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_DONT_REORDER = BIT(8), 958 IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_MCAST_MLO_FIRST_TX = BIT(9), 959 IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_MLO_LINK = 0xf0000000, 960 }; 961 962 #define IEEE80211_LINK_UNSPECIFIED 0xf 963 #define IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_MLO_LINK_UNSPEC \ 964 u32_encode_bits(IEEE80211_LINK_UNSPECIFIED, \ 965 IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_MLO_LINK) 966 967 /** 968 * enum mac80211_tx_status_flags - flags to describe transmit status 969 * 970 * @IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_ACK_SIGNAL_VALID: ACK signal is valid 971 * 972 * These flags are used in tx_info->status.flags. 973 */ 974 enum mac80211_tx_status_flags { 975 IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_ACK_SIGNAL_VALID = BIT(0), 976 }; 977 978 /* 979 * This definition is used as a mask to clear all temporary flags, which are 980 * set by the tx handlers for each transmission attempt by the mac80211 stack. 981 */ 982 #define IEEE80211_TX_TEMPORARY_FLAGS (IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_ACK | \ 983 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_CLEAR_PS_FILT | IEEE80211_TX_CTL_FIRST_FRAGMENT | \ 984 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_SEND_AFTER_DTIM | IEEE80211_TX_CTL_AMPDU | \ 985 IEEE80211_TX_STAT_TX_FILTERED | IEEE80211_TX_STAT_ACK | \ 986 IEEE80211_TX_STAT_AMPDU | IEEE80211_TX_STAT_AMPDU_NO_BACK | \ 987 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_RATE_CTRL_PROBE | IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_PS_BUFFER | \ 988 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_MORE_FRAMES | IEEE80211_TX_CTL_LDPC | \ 989 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_STBC | IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP) 990 991 /** 992 * enum mac80211_rate_control_flags - per-rate flags set by the 993 * Rate Control algorithm. 994 * 995 * These flags are set by the Rate control algorithm for each rate during tx, 996 * in the @flags member of struct ieee80211_tx_rate. 997 * 998 * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_USE_RTS_CTS: Use RTS/CTS exchange for this rate. 999 * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_USE_CTS_PROTECT: CTS-to-self protection is required. 1000 * This is set if the current BSS requires ERP protection. 1001 * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_USE_SHORT_PREAMBLE: Use short preamble. 1002 * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_MCS: HT rate. 1003 * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_VHT_MCS: VHT MCS rate, in this case the idx field is split 1004 * into a higher 4 bits (Nss) and lower 4 bits (MCS number) 1005 * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_GREEN_FIELD: Indicates whether this rate should be used in 1006 * Greenfield mode. 1007 * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_40_MHZ_WIDTH: Indicates if the Channel Width should be 40 MHz. 1008 * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_80_MHZ_WIDTH: Indicates 80 MHz transmission 1009 * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_160_MHZ_WIDTH: Indicates 160 MHz transmission 1010 * (80+80 isn't supported yet) 1011 * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_DUP_DATA: The frame should be transmitted on both of the 1012 * adjacent 20 MHz channels, if the current channel type is 1013 * NL80211_CHAN_HT40MINUS or NL80211_CHAN_HT40PLUS. 1014 * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_SHORT_GI: Short Guard interval should be used for this rate. 1015 */ 1016 enum mac80211_rate_control_flags { 1017 IEEE80211_TX_RC_USE_RTS_CTS = BIT(0), 1018 IEEE80211_TX_RC_USE_CTS_PROTECT = BIT(1), 1019 IEEE80211_TX_RC_USE_SHORT_PREAMBLE = BIT(2), 1020 1021 /* rate index is an HT/VHT MCS instead of an index */ 1022 IEEE80211_TX_RC_MCS = BIT(3), 1023 IEEE80211_TX_RC_GREEN_FIELD = BIT(4), 1024 IEEE80211_TX_RC_40_MHZ_WIDTH = BIT(5), 1025 IEEE80211_TX_RC_DUP_DATA = BIT(6), 1026 IEEE80211_TX_RC_SHORT_GI = BIT(7), 1027 IEEE80211_TX_RC_VHT_MCS = BIT(8), 1028 IEEE80211_TX_RC_80_MHZ_WIDTH = BIT(9), 1029 IEEE80211_TX_RC_160_MHZ_WIDTH = BIT(10), 1030 }; 1031 1032 1033 /* there are 40 bytes if you don't need the rateset to be kept */ 1034 #define IEEE80211_TX_INFO_DRIVER_DATA_SIZE 40 1035 1036 /* if you do need the rateset, then you have less space */ 1037 #define IEEE80211_TX_INFO_RATE_DRIVER_DATA_SIZE 24 1038 1039 /* maximum number of rate stages */ 1040 #define IEEE80211_TX_MAX_RATES 4 1041 1042 /* maximum number of rate table entries */ 1043 #define IEEE80211_TX_RATE_TABLE_SIZE 4 1044 1045 /** 1046 * struct ieee80211_tx_rate - rate selection/status 1047 * 1048 * @idx: rate index to attempt to send with 1049 * @flags: rate control flags (&enum mac80211_rate_control_flags) 1050 * @count: number of tries in this rate before going to the next rate 1051 * 1052 * A value of -1 for @idx indicates an invalid rate and, if used 1053 * in an array of retry rates, that no more rates should be tried. 1054 * 1055 * When used for transmit status reporting, the driver should 1056 * always report the rate along with the flags it used. 1057 * 1058 * &struct ieee80211_tx_info contains an array of these structs 1059 * in the control information, and it will be filled by the rate 1060 * control algorithm according to what should be sent. For example, 1061 * if this array contains, in the format { <idx>, <count> } the 1062 * information:: 1063 * 1064 * { 3, 2 }, { 2, 2 }, { 1, 4 }, { -1, 0 }, { -1, 0 } 1065 * 1066 * then this means that the frame should be transmitted 1067 * up to twice at rate 3, up to twice at rate 2, and up to four 1068 * times at rate 1 if it doesn't get acknowledged. Say it gets 1069 * acknowledged by the peer after the fifth attempt, the status 1070 * information should then contain:: 1071 * 1072 * { 3, 2 }, { 2, 2 }, { 1, 1 }, { -1, 0 } ... 1073 * 1074 * since it was transmitted twice at rate 3, twice at rate 2 1075 * and once at rate 1 after which we received an acknowledgement. 1076 */ 1077 struct ieee80211_tx_rate { 1078 s8 idx; 1079 u16 count:5, 1080 flags:11; 1081 } __packed; 1082 1083 #define IEEE80211_MAX_TX_RETRY 31 1084 1085 static inline void ieee80211_rate_set_vht(struct ieee80211_tx_rate *rate, 1086 u8 mcs, u8 nss) 1087 { 1088 WARN_ON(mcs & ~0xF); 1089 WARN_ON((nss - 1) & ~0x7); 1090 rate->idx = ((nss - 1) << 4) | mcs; 1091 } 1092 1093 static inline u8 1094 ieee80211_rate_get_vht_mcs(const struct ieee80211_tx_rate *rate) 1095 { 1096 return rate->idx & 0xF; 1097 } 1098 1099 static inline u8 1100 ieee80211_rate_get_vht_nss(const struct ieee80211_tx_rate *rate) 1101 { 1102 return (rate->idx >> 4) + 1; 1103 } 1104 1105 /** 1106 * struct ieee80211_tx_info - skb transmit information 1107 * 1108 * This structure is placed in skb->cb for three uses: 1109 * (1) mac80211 TX control - mac80211 tells the driver what to do 1110 * (2) driver internal use (if applicable) 1111 * (3) TX status information - driver tells mac80211 what happened 1112 * 1113 * @flags: transmit info flags, defined above 1114 * @band: the band to transmit on (use e.g. for checking for races), 1115 * not valid if the interface is an MLD since we won't know which 1116 * link the frame will be transmitted on 1117 * @hw_queue: HW queue to put the frame on, skb_get_queue_mapping() gives the AC 1118 * @ack_frame_id: internal frame ID for TX status, used internally 1119 * @tx_time_est: TX time estimate in units of 4us, used internally 1120 * @control: union part for control data 1121 * @control.rates: TX rates array to try 1122 * @control.rts_cts_rate_idx: rate for RTS or CTS 1123 * @control.use_rts: use RTS 1124 * @control.use_cts_prot: use RTS/CTS 1125 * @control.short_preamble: use short preamble (CCK only) 1126 * @control.skip_table: skip externally configured rate table 1127 * @control.jiffies: timestamp for expiry on powersave clients 1128 * @control.vif: virtual interface (may be NULL) 1129 * @control.hw_key: key to encrypt with (may be NULL) 1130 * @control.flags: control flags, see &enum mac80211_tx_control_flags 1131 * @control.enqueue_time: enqueue time (for iTXQs) 1132 * @driver_rates: alias to @control.rates to reserve space 1133 * @pad: padding 1134 * @rate_driver_data: driver use area if driver needs @control.rates 1135 * @status: union part for status data 1136 * @status.rates: attempted rates 1137 * @status.ack_signal: ACK signal 1138 * @status.ampdu_ack_len: AMPDU ack length 1139 * @status.ampdu_len: AMPDU length 1140 * @status.antenna: (legacy, kept only for iwlegacy) 1141 * @status.tx_time: airtime consumed for transmission; note this is only 1142 * used for WMM AC, not for airtime fairness 1143 * @status.flags: status flags, see &enum mac80211_tx_status_flags 1144 * @status.status_driver_data: driver use area 1145 * @ack: union part for pure ACK data 1146 * @ack.cookie: cookie for the ACK 1147 * @driver_data: array of driver_data pointers 1148 * @ampdu_ack_len: number of acked aggregated frames. 1149 * relevant only if IEEE80211_TX_STAT_AMPDU was set. 1150 * @ampdu_len: number of aggregated frames. 1151 * relevant only if IEEE80211_TX_STAT_AMPDU was set. 1152 * @ack_signal: signal strength of the ACK frame 1153 */ 1154 struct ieee80211_tx_info { 1155 /* common information */ 1156 u32 flags; 1157 u32 band:3, 1158 ack_frame_id:13, 1159 hw_queue:4, 1160 tx_time_est:10; 1161 /* 2 free bits */ 1162 1163 union { 1164 struct { 1165 union { 1166 /* rate control */ 1167 struct { 1168 struct ieee80211_tx_rate rates[ 1169 IEEE80211_TX_MAX_RATES]; 1170 s8 rts_cts_rate_idx; 1171 u8 use_rts:1; 1172 u8 use_cts_prot:1; 1173 u8 short_preamble:1; 1174 u8 skip_table:1; 1175 /* 2 bytes free */ 1176 }; 1177 /* only needed before rate control */ 1178 unsigned long jiffies; 1179 }; 1180 /* NB: vif can be NULL for injected frames */ 1181 struct ieee80211_vif *vif; 1182 struct ieee80211_key_conf *hw_key; 1183 u32 flags; 1184 codel_time_t enqueue_time; 1185 } control; 1186 struct { 1187 u64 cookie; 1188 } ack; 1189 struct { 1190 struct ieee80211_tx_rate rates[IEEE80211_TX_MAX_RATES]; 1191 s32 ack_signal; 1192 u8 ampdu_ack_len; 1193 u8 ampdu_len; 1194 u8 antenna; 1195 u8 pad; 1196 u16 tx_time; 1197 u8 flags; 1198 u8 pad2; 1199 void *status_driver_data[16 / sizeof(void *)]; 1200 } status; 1201 struct { 1202 struct ieee80211_tx_rate driver_rates[ 1203 IEEE80211_TX_MAX_RATES]; 1204 u8 pad[4]; 1205 1206 void *rate_driver_data[ 1207 IEEE80211_TX_INFO_RATE_DRIVER_DATA_SIZE / sizeof(void *)]; 1208 }; 1209 void *driver_data[ 1210 IEEE80211_TX_INFO_DRIVER_DATA_SIZE / sizeof(void *)]; 1211 }; 1212 }; 1213 1214 static inline u16 1215 ieee80211_info_set_tx_time_est(struct ieee80211_tx_info *info, u16 tx_time_est) 1216 { 1217 /* We only have 10 bits in tx_time_est, so store airtime 1218 * in increments of 4us and clamp the maximum to 2**12-1 1219 */ 1220 info->tx_time_est = min_t(u16, tx_time_est, 4095) >> 2; 1221 return info->tx_time_est << 2; 1222 } 1223 1224 static inline u16 1225 ieee80211_info_get_tx_time_est(struct ieee80211_tx_info *info) 1226 { 1227 return info->tx_time_est << 2; 1228 } 1229 1230 /*** 1231 * struct ieee80211_rate_status - mrr stage for status path 1232 * 1233 * This struct is used in struct ieee80211_tx_status to provide drivers a 1234 * dynamic way to report about used rates and power levels per packet. 1235 * 1236 * @rate_idx The actual used rate. 1237 * @try_count How often the rate was tried. 1238 * @tx_power_idx An idx into the ieee80211_hw->tx_power_levels list of the 1239 * corresponding wifi hardware. The idx shall point to the power level 1240 * that was used when sending the packet. 1241 */ 1242 struct ieee80211_rate_status { 1243 struct rate_info rate_idx; 1244 u8 try_count; 1245 u8 tx_power_idx; 1246 }; 1247 1248 /** 1249 * struct ieee80211_tx_status - extended tx status info for rate control 1250 * 1251 * @sta: Station that the packet was transmitted for 1252 * @info: Basic tx status information 1253 * @skb: Packet skb (can be NULL if not provided by the driver) 1254 * @rates: Mrr stages that were used when sending the packet 1255 * @n_rates: Number of mrr stages (count of instances for @rates) 1256 * @free_list: list where processed skbs are stored to be free'd by the driver 1257 * @ack_hwtstamp: Hardware timestamp of the received ack in nanoseconds 1258 * Only needed for Timing measurement and Fine timing measurement action 1259 * frames. Only reported by devices that have timestamping enabled. 1260 */ 1261 struct ieee80211_tx_status { 1262 struct ieee80211_sta *sta; 1263 struct ieee80211_tx_info *info; 1264 struct sk_buff *skb; 1265 struct ieee80211_rate_status *rates; 1266 ktime_t ack_hwtstamp; 1267 u8 n_rates; 1268 1269 struct list_head *free_list; 1270 }; 1271 1272 /** 1273 * struct ieee80211_scan_ies - descriptors for different blocks of IEs 1274 * 1275 * This structure is used to point to different blocks of IEs in HW scan 1276 * and scheduled scan. These blocks contain the IEs passed by userspace 1277 * and the ones generated by mac80211. 1278 * 1279 * @ies: pointers to band specific IEs. 1280 * @len: lengths of band_specific IEs. 1281 * @common_ies: IEs for all bands (especially vendor specific ones) 1282 * @common_ie_len: length of the common_ies 1283 */ 1284 struct ieee80211_scan_ies { 1285 const u8 *ies[NUM_NL80211_BANDS]; 1286 size_t len[NUM_NL80211_BANDS]; 1287 const u8 *common_ies; 1288 size_t common_ie_len; 1289 }; 1290 1291 1292 static inline struct ieee80211_tx_info *IEEE80211_SKB_CB(struct sk_buff *skb) 1293 { 1294 return (struct ieee80211_tx_info *)skb->cb; 1295 } 1296 1297 static inline struct ieee80211_rx_status *IEEE80211_SKB_RXCB(struct sk_buff *skb) 1298 { 1299 return (struct ieee80211_rx_status *)skb->cb; 1300 } 1301 1302 /** 1303 * ieee80211_tx_info_clear_status - clear TX status 1304 * 1305 * @info: The &struct ieee80211_tx_info to be cleared. 1306 * 1307 * When the driver passes an skb back to mac80211, it must report 1308 * a number of things in TX status. This function clears everything 1309 * in the TX status but the rate control information (it does clear 1310 * the count since you need to fill that in anyway). 1311 * 1312 * NOTE: While the rates array is kept intact, this will wipe all of the 1313 * driver_data fields in info, so it's up to the driver to restore 1314 * any fields it needs after calling this helper. 1315 */ 1316 static inline void 1317 ieee80211_tx_info_clear_status(struct ieee80211_tx_info *info) 1318 { 1319 int i; 1320 1321 BUILD_BUG_ON(offsetof(struct ieee80211_tx_info, status.rates) != 1322 offsetof(struct ieee80211_tx_info, control.rates)); 1323 BUILD_BUG_ON(offsetof(struct ieee80211_tx_info, status.rates) != 1324 offsetof(struct ieee80211_tx_info, driver_rates)); 1325 BUILD_BUG_ON(offsetof(struct ieee80211_tx_info, status.rates) != 8); 1326 /* clear the rate counts */ 1327 for (i = 0; i < IEEE80211_TX_MAX_RATES; i++) 1328 info->status.rates[i].count = 0; 1329 memset_after(&info->status, 0, rates); 1330 } 1331 1332 1333 /** 1334 * enum mac80211_rx_flags - receive flags 1335 * 1336 * These flags are used with the @flag member of &struct ieee80211_rx_status. 1337 * @RX_FLAG_MMIC_ERROR: Michael MIC error was reported on this frame. 1338 * Use together with %RX_FLAG_MMIC_STRIPPED. 1339 * @RX_FLAG_DECRYPTED: This frame was decrypted in hardware. 1340 * @RX_FLAG_MMIC_STRIPPED: the Michael MIC is stripped off this frame, 1341 * verification has been done by the hardware. 1342 * @RX_FLAG_IV_STRIPPED: The IV and ICV are stripped from this frame. 1343 * If this flag is set, the stack cannot do any replay detection 1344 * hence the driver or hardware will have to do that. 1345 * @RX_FLAG_PN_VALIDATED: Currently only valid for CCMP/GCMP frames, this 1346 * flag indicates that the PN was verified for replay protection. 1347 * Note that this flag is also currently only supported when a frame 1348 * is also decrypted (ie. @RX_FLAG_DECRYPTED must be set) 1349 * @RX_FLAG_DUP_VALIDATED: The driver should set this flag if it did 1350 * de-duplication by itself. 1351 * @RX_FLAG_FAILED_FCS_CRC: Set this flag if the FCS check failed on 1352 * the frame. 1353 * @RX_FLAG_FAILED_PLCP_CRC: Set this flag if the PCLP check failed on 1354 * the frame. 1355 * @RX_FLAG_MACTIME_START: The timestamp passed in the RX status (@mactime 1356 * field) is valid and contains the time the first symbol of the MPDU 1357 * was received. This is useful in monitor mode and for proper IBSS 1358 * merging. 1359 * @RX_FLAG_MACTIME_END: The timestamp passed in the RX status (@mactime 1360 * field) is valid and contains the time the last symbol of the MPDU 1361 * (including FCS) was received. 1362 * @RX_FLAG_MACTIME_PLCP_START: The timestamp passed in the RX status (@mactime 1363 * field) is valid and contains the time the SYNC preamble was received. 1364 * @RX_FLAG_NO_SIGNAL_VAL: The signal strength value is not present. 1365 * Valid only for data frames (mainly A-MPDU) 1366 * @RX_FLAG_AMPDU_DETAILS: A-MPDU details are known, in particular the reference 1367 * number (@ampdu_reference) must be populated and be a distinct number for 1368 * each A-MPDU 1369 * @RX_FLAG_AMPDU_LAST_KNOWN: last subframe is known, should be set on all 1370 * subframes of a single A-MPDU 1371 * @RX_FLAG_AMPDU_IS_LAST: this subframe is the last subframe of the A-MPDU 1372 * @RX_FLAG_AMPDU_DELIM_CRC_ERROR: A delimiter CRC error has been detected 1373 * on this subframe 1374 * @RX_FLAG_AMPDU_DELIM_CRC_KNOWN: The delimiter CRC field is known (the CRC 1375 * is stored in the @ampdu_delimiter_crc field) 1376 * @RX_FLAG_MIC_STRIPPED: The mic was stripped of this packet. Decryption was 1377 * done by the hardware 1378 * @RX_FLAG_ONLY_MONITOR: Report frame only to monitor interfaces without 1379 * processing it in any regular way. 1380 * This is useful if drivers offload some frames but still want to report 1381 * them for sniffing purposes. 1382 * @RX_FLAG_SKIP_MONITOR: Process and report frame to all interfaces except 1383 * monitor interfaces. 1384 * This is useful if drivers offload some frames but still want to report 1385 * them for sniffing purposes. 1386 * @RX_FLAG_AMSDU_MORE: Some drivers may prefer to report separate A-MSDU 1387 * subframes instead of a one huge frame for performance reasons. 1388 * All, but the last MSDU from an A-MSDU should have this flag set. E.g. 1389 * if an A-MSDU has 3 frames, the first 2 must have the flag set, while 1390 * the 3rd (last) one must not have this flag set. The flag is used to 1391 * deal with retransmission/duplication recovery properly since A-MSDU 1392 * subframes share the same sequence number. Reported subframes can be 1393 * either regular MSDU or singly A-MSDUs. Subframes must not be 1394 * interleaved with other frames. 1395 * @RX_FLAG_RADIOTAP_TLV_AT_END: This frame contains radiotap TLVs in the 1396 * skb->data (before the 802.11 header). 1397 * If used, the SKB's mac_header pointer must be set to point 1398 * to the 802.11 header after the TLVs, and any padding added after TLV 1399 * data to align to 4 must be cleared by the driver putting the TLVs 1400 * in the skb. 1401 * @RX_FLAG_ALLOW_SAME_PN: Allow the same PN as same packet before. 1402 * This is used for AMSDU subframes which can have the same PN as 1403 * the first subframe. 1404 * @RX_FLAG_ICV_STRIPPED: The ICV is stripped from this frame. CRC checking must 1405 * be done in the hardware. 1406 * @RX_FLAG_AMPDU_EOF_BIT: Value of the EOF bit in the A-MPDU delimiter for this 1407 * frame 1408 * @RX_FLAG_AMPDU_EOF_BIT_KNOWN: The EOF value is known 1409 * @RX_FLAG_RADIOTAP_HE: HE radiotap data is present 1410 * (&struct ieee80211_radiotap_he, mac80211 will fill in 1411 * 1412 * - DATA3_DATA_MCS 1413 * - DATA3_DATA_DCM 1414 * - DATA3_CODING 1415 * - DATA5_GI 1416 * - DATA5_DATA_BW_RU_ALLOC 1417 * - DATA6_NSTS 1418 * - DATA3_STBC 1419 * 1420 * from the RX info data, so leave those zeroed when building this data) 1421 * @RX_FLAG_RADIOTAP_HE_MU: HE MU radiotap data is present 1422 * (&struct ieee80211_radiotap_he_mu) 1423 * @RX_FLAG_RADIOTAP_LSIG: L-SIG radiotap data is present 1424 * @RX_FLAG_NO_PSDU: use the frame only for radiotap reporting, with 1425 * the "0-length PSDU" field included there. The value for it is 1426 * in &struct ieee80211_rx_status. Note that if this value isn't 1427 * known the frame shouldn't be reported. 1428 * @RX_FLAG_8023: the frame has an 802.3 header (decap offload performed by 1429 * hardware or driver) 1430 */ 1431 enum mac80211_rx_flags { 1432 RX_FLAG_MMIC_ERROR = BIT(0), 1433 RX_FLAG_DECRYPTED = BIT(1), 1434 RX_FLAG_MACTIME_PLCP_START = BIT(2), 1435 RX_FLAG_MMIC_STRIPPED = BIT(3), 1436 RX_FLAG_IV_STRIPPED = BIT(4), 1437 RX_FLAG_FAILED_FCS_CRC = BIT(5), 1438 RX_FLAG_FAILED_PLCP_CRC = BIT(6), 1439 RX_FLAG_MACTIME_START = BIT(7), 1440 RX_FLAG_NO_SIGNAL_VAL = BIT(8), 1441 RX_FLAG_AMPDU_DETAILS = BIT(9), 1442 RX_FLAG_PN_VALIDATED = BIT(10), 1443 RX_FLAG_DUP_VALIDATED = BIT(11), 1444 RX_FLAG_AMPDU_LAST_KNOWN = BIT(12), 1445 RX_FLAG_AMPDU_IS_LAST = BIT(13), 1446 RX_FLAG_AMPDU_DELIM_CRC_ERROR = BIT(14), 1447 RX_FLAG_AMPDU_DELIM_CRC_KNOWN = BIT(15), 1448 RX_FLAG_MACTIME_END = BIT(16), 1449 RX_FLAG_ONLY_MONITOR = BIT(17), 1450 RX_FLAG_SKIP_MONITOR = BIT(18), 1451 RX_FLAG_AMSDU_MORE = BIT(19), 1452 RX_FLAG_RADIOTAP_TLV_AT_END = BIT(20), 1453 RX_FLAG_MIC_STRIPPED = BIT(21), 1454 RX_FLAG_ALLOW_SAME_PN = BIT(22), 1455 RX_FLAG_ICV_STRIPPED = BIT(23), 1456 RX_FLAG_AMPDU_EOF_BIT = BIT(24), 1457 RX_FLAG_AMPDU_EOF_BIT_KNOWN = BIT(25), 1458 RX_FLAG_RADIOTAP_HE = BIT(26), 1459 RX_FLAG_RADIOTAP_HE_MU = BIT(27), 1460 RX_FLAG_RADIOTAP_LSIG = BIT(28), 1461 RX_FLAG_NO_PSDU = BIT(29), 1462 RX_FLAG_8023 = BIT(30), 1463 }; 1464 1465 /** 1466 * enum mac80211_rx_encoding_flags - MCS & bandwidth flags 1467 * 1468 * @RX_ENC_FLAG_SHORTPRE: Short preamble was used for this frame 1469 * @RX_ENC_FLAG_SHORT_GI: Short guard interval was used 1470 * @RX_ENC_FLAG_HT_GF: This frame was received in a HT-greenfield transmission, 1471 * if the driver fills this value it should add 1472 * %IEEE80211_RADIOTAP_MCS_HAVE_FMT 1473 * to @hw.radiotap_mcs_details to advertise that fact. 1474 * @RX_ENC_FLAG_LDPC: LDPC was used 1475 * @RX_ENC_FLAG_STBC_MASK: STBC 2 bit bitmask. 1 - Nss=1, 2 - Nss=2, 3 - Nss=3 1476 * @RX_ENC_FLAG_BF: packet was beamformed 1477 */ 1478 enum mac80211_rx_encoding_flags { 1479 RX_ENC_FLAG_SHORTPRE = BIT(0), 1480 RX_ENC_FLAG_SHORT_GI = BIT(2), 1481 RX_ENC_FLAG_HT_GF = BIT(3), 1482 RX_ENC_FLAG_STBC_MASK = BIT(4) | BIT(5), 1483 RX_ENC_FLAG_LDPC = BIT(6), 1484 RX_ENC_FLAG_BF = BIT(7), 1485 }; 1486 1487 #define RX_ENC_FLAG_STBC_SHIFT 4 1488 1489 enum mac80211_rx_encoding { 1490 RX_ENC_LEGACY = 0, 1491 RX_ENC_HT, 1492 RX_ENC_VHT, 1493 RX_ENC_HE, 1494 RX_ENC_EHT, 1495 }; 1496 1497 /** 1498 * struct ieee80211_rx_status - receive status 1499 * 1500 * The low-level driver should provide this information (the subset 1501 * supported by hardware) to the 802.11 code with each received 1502 * frame, in the skb's control buffer (cb). 1503 * 1504 * @mactime: value in microseconds of the 64-bit Time Synchronization Function 1505 * (TSF) timer when the first data symbol (MPDU) arrived at the hardware. 1506 * @boottime_ns: CLOCK_BOOTTIME timestamp the frame was received at, this is 1507 * needed only for beacons and probe responses that update the scan cache. 1508 * @ack_tx_hwtstamp: Hardware timestamp for the ack TX in nanoseconds. Only 1509 * needed for Timing measurement and Fine timing measurement action frames. 1510 * Only reported by devices that have timestamping enabled. 1511 * @device_timestamp: arbitrary timestamp for the device, mac80211 doesn't use 1512 * it but can store it and pass it back to the driver for synchronisation 1513 * @band: the active band when this frame was received 1514 * @freq: frequency the radio was tuned to when receiving this frame, in MHz 1515 * This field must be set for management frames, but isn't strictly needed 1516 * for data (other) frames - for those it only affects radiotap reporting. 1517 * @freq_offset: @freq has a positive offset of 500Khz. 1518 * @signal: signal strength when receiving this frame, either in dBm, in dB or 1519 * unspecified depending on the hardware capabilities flags 1520 * @IEEE80211_HW_SIGNAL_* 1521 * @chains: bitmask of receive chains for which separate signal strength 1522 * values were filled. 1523 * @chain_signal: per-chain signal strength, in dBm (unlike @signal, doesn't 1524 * support dB or unspecified units) 1525 * @antenna: antenna used 1526 * @rate_idx: index of data rate into band's supported rates or MCS index if 1527 * HT or VHT is used (%RX_FLAG_HT/%RX_FLAG_VHT) 1528 * @nss: number of streams (VHT, HE and EHT only) 1529 * @flag: %RX_FLAG_\* 1530 * @encoding: &enum mac80211_rx_encoding 1531 * @bw: &enum rate_info_bw 1532 * @enc_flags: uses bits from &enum mac80211_rx_encoding_flags 1533 * @he_ru: HE RU, from &enum nl80211_he_ru_alloc 1534 * @he_gi: HE GI, from &enum nl80211_he_gi 1535 * @he_dcm: HE DCM value 1536 * @eht: EHT specific rate information 1537 * @eht.ru: EHT RU, from &enum nl80211_eht_ru_alloc 1538 * @eht.gi: EHT GI, from &enum nl80211_eht_gi 1539 * @rx_flags: internal RX flags for mac80211 1540 * @ampdu_reference: A-MPDU reference number, must be a different value for 1541 * each A-MPDU but the same for each subframe within one A-MPDU 1542 * @ampdu_delimiter_crc: A-MPDU delimiter CRC 1543 * @zero_length_psdu_type: radiotap type of the 0-length PSDU 1544 * @link_valid: if the link which is identified by @link_id is valid. This flag 1545 * is set only when connection is MLO. 1546 * @link_id: id of the link used to receive the packet. This is used along with 1547 * @link_valid. 1548 */ 1549 struct ieee80211_rx_status { 1550 u64 mactime; 1551 union { 1552 u64 boottime_ns; 1553 ktime_t ack_tx_hwtstamp; 1554 }; 1555 u32 device_timestamp; 1556 u32 ampdu_reference; 1557 u32 flag; 1558 u16 freq: 13, freq_offset: 1; 1559 u8 enc_flags; 1560 u8 encoding:3, bw:4; 1561 union { 1562 struct { 1563 u8 he_ru:3; 1564 u8 he_gi:2; 1565 u8 he_dcm:1; 1566 }; 1567 struct { 1568 u8 ru:4; 1569 u8 gi:2; 1570 } eht; 1571 }; 1572 u8 rate_idx; 1573 u8 nss; 1574 u8 rx_flags; 1575 u8 band; 1576 u8 antenna; 1577 s8 signal; 1578 u8 chains; 1579 s8 chain_signal[IEEE80211_MAX_CHAINS]; 1580 u8 ampdu_delimiter_crc; 1581 u8 zero_length_psdu_type; 1582 u8 link_valid:1, link_id:4; 1583 }; 1584 1585 static inline u32 1586 ieee80211_rx_status_to_khz(struct ieee80211_rx_status *rx_status) 1587 { 1588 return MHZ_TO_KHZ(rx_status->freq) + 1589 (rx_status->freq_offset ? 500 : 0); 1590 } 1591 1592 /** 1593 * enum ieee80211_conf_flags - configuration flags 1594 * 1595 * Flags to define PHY configuration options 1596 * 1597 * @IEEE80211_CONF_MONITOR: there's a monitor interface present -- use this 1598 * to determine for example whether to calculate timestamps for packets 1599 * or not, do not use instead of filter flags! 1600 * @IEEE80211_CONF_PS: Enable 802.11 power save mode (managed mode only). 1601 * This is the power save mode defined by IEEE 802.11-2007 section 11.2, 1602 * meaning that the hardware still wakes up for beacons, is able to 1603 * transmit frames and receive the possible acknowledgment frames. 1604 * Not to be confused with hardware specific wakeup/sleep states, 1605 * driver is responsible for that. See the section "Powersave support" 1606 * for more. 1607 * @IEEE80211_CONF_IDLE: The device is running, but idle; if the flag is set 1608 * the driver should be prepared to handle configuration requests but 1609 * may turn the device off as much as possible. Typically, this flag will 1610 * be set when an interface is set UP but not associated or scanning, but 1611 * it can also be unset in that case when monitor interfaces are active. 1612 * @IEEE80211_CONF_OFFCHANNEL: The device is currently not on its main 1613 * operating channel. 1614 */ 1615 enum ieee80211_conf_flags { 1616 IEEE80211_CONF_MONITOR = (1<<0), 1617 IEEE80211_CONF_PS = (1<<1), 1618 IEEE80211_CONF_IDLE = (1<<2), 1619 IEEE80211_CONF_OFFCHANNEL = (1<<3), 1620 }; 1621 1622 1623 /** 1624 * enum ieee80211_conf_changed - denotes which configuration changed 1625 * 1626 * @IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_LISTEN_INTERVAL: the listen interval changed 1627 * @IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_MONITOR: the monitor flag changed 1628 * @IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_PS: the PS flag or dynamic PS timeout changed 1629 * @IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_POWER: the TX power changed 1630 * @IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_CHANNEL: the channel/channel_type changed 1631 * @IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_RETRY_LIMITS: retry limits changed 1632 * @IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_IDLE: Idle flag changed 1633 * @IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_SMPS: Spatial multiplexing powersave mode changed 1634 * Note that this is only valid if channel contexts are not used, 1635 * otherwise each channel context has the number of chains listed. 1636 */ 1637 enum ieee80211_conf_changed { 1638 IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_SMPS = BIT(1), 1639 IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_LISTEN_INTERVAL = BIT(2), 1640 IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_MONITOR = BIT(3), 1641 IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_PS = BIT(4), 1642 IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_POWER = BIT(5), 1643 IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_CHANNEL = BIT(6), 1644 IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_RETRY_LIMITS = BIT(7), 1645 IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_IDLE = BIT(8), 1646 }; 1647 1648 /** 1649 * enum ieee80211_smps_mode - spatial multiplexing power save mode 1650 * 1651 * @IEEE80211_SMPS_AUTOMATIC: automatic 1652 * @IEEE80211_SMPS_OFF: off 1653 * @IEEE80211_SMPS_STATIC: static 1654 * @IEEE80211_SMPS_DYNAMIC: dynamic 1655 * @IEEE80211_SMPS_NUM_MODES: internal, don't use 1656 */ 1657 enum ieee80211_smps_mode { 1658 IEEE80211_SMPS_AUTOMATIC, 1659 IEEE80211_SMPS_OFF, 1660 IEEE80211_SMPS_STATIC, 1661 IEEE80211_SMPS_DYNAMIC, 1662 1663 /* keep last */ 1664 IEEE80211_SMPS_NUM_MODES, 1665 }; 1666 1667 /** 1668 * struct ieee80211_conf - configuration of the device 1669 * 1670 * This struct indicates how the driver shall configure the hardware. 1671 * 1672 * @flags: configuration flags defined above 1673 * 1674 * @listen_interval: listen interval in units of beacon interval 1675 * @ps_dtim_period: The DTIM period of the AP we're connected to, for use 1676 * in power saving. Power saving will not be enabled until a beacon 1677 * has been received and the DTIM period is known. 1678 * @dynamic_ps_timeout: The dynamic powersave timeout (in ms), see the 1679 * powersave documentation below. This variable is valid only when 1680 * the CONF_PS flag is set. 1681 * 1682 * @power_level: requested transmit power (in dBm), backward compatibility 1683 * value only that is set to the minimum of all interfaces 1684 * 1685 * @chandef: the channel definition to tune to 1686 * @radar_enabled: whether radar detection is enabled 1687 * 1688 * @long_frame_max_tx_count: Maximum number of transmissions for a "long" frame 1689 * (a frame not RTS protected), called "dot11LongRetryLimit" in 802.11, 1690 * but actually means the number of transmissions not the number of retries 1691 * @short_frame_max_tx_count: Maximum number of transmissions for a "short" 1692 * frame, called "dot11ShortRetryLimit" in 802.11, but actually means the 1693 * number of transmissions not the number of retries 1694 * 1695 * @smps_mode: spatial multiplexing powersave mode; note that 1696 * %IEEE80211_SMPS_STATIC is used when the device is not 1697 * configured for an HT channel. 1698 * Note that this is only valid if channel contexts are not used, 1699 * otherwise each channel context has the number of chains listed. 1700 */ 1701 struct ieee80211_conf { 1702 u32 flags; 1703 int power_level, dynamic_ps_timeout; 1704 1705 u16 listen_interval; 1706 u8 ps_dtim_period; 1707 1708 u8 long_frame_max_tx_count, short_frame_max_tx_count; 1709 1710 struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef; 1711 bool radar_enabled; 1712 enum ieee80211_smps_mode smps_mode; 1713 }; 1714 1715 /** 1716 * struct ieee80211_channel_switch - holds the channel switch data 1717 * 1718 * The information provided in this structure is required for channel switch 1719 * operation. 1720 * 1721 * @timestamp: value in microseconds of the 64-bit Time Synchronization 1722 * Function (TSF) timer when the frame containing the channel switch 1723 * announcement was received. This is simply the rx.mactime parameter 1724 * the driver passed into mac80211. 1725 * @device_timestamp: arbitrary timestamp for the device, this is the 1726 * rx.device_timestamp parameter the driver passed to mac80211. 1727 * @block_tx: Indicates whether transmission must be blocked before the 1728 * scheduled channel switch, as indicated by the AP. 1729 * @chandef: the new channel to switch to 1730 * @count: the number of TBTT's until the channel switch event 1731 * @delay: maximum delay between the time the AP transmitted the last beacon in 1732 * current channel and the expected time of the first beacon in the new 1733 * channel, expressed in TU. 1734 */ 1735 struct ieee80211_channel_switch { 1736 u64 timestamp; 1737 u32 device_timestamp; 1738 bool block_tx; 1739 struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef; 1740 u8 count; 1741 u32 delay; 1742 }; 1743 1744 /** 1745 * enum ieee80211_vif_flags - virtual interface flags 1746 * 1747 * @IEEE80211_VIF_BEACON_FILTER: the device performs beacon filtering 1748 * on this virtual interface to avoid unnecessary CPU wakeups 1749 * @IEEE80211_VIF_SUPPORTS_CQM_RSSI: the device can do connection quality 1750 * monitoring on this virtual interface -- i.e. it can monitor 1751 * connection quality related parameters, such as the RSSI level and 1752 * provide notifications if configured trigger levels are reached. 1753 * @IEEE80211_VIF_SUPPORTS_UAPSD: The device can do U-APSD for this 1754 * interface. This flag should be set during interface addition, 1755 * but may be set/cleared as late as authentication to an AP. It is 1756 * only valid for managed/station mode interfaces. 1757 * @IEEE80211_VIF_GET_NOA_UPDATE: request to handle NOA attributes 1758 * and send P2P_PS notification to the driver if NOA changed, even 1759 * this is not pure P2P vif. 1760 * @IEEE80211_VIF_DISABLE_SMPS_OVERRIDE: disable user configuration of 1761 * SMPS mode via debugfs. 1762 */ 1763 enum ieee80211_vif_flags { 1764 IEEE80211_VIF_BEACON_FILTER = BIT(0), 1765 IEEE80211_VIF_SUPPORTS_CQM_RSSI = BIT(1), 1766 IEEE80211_VIF_SUPPORTS_UAPSD = BIT(2), 1767 IEEE80211_VIF_GET_NOA_UPDATE = BIT(3), 1768 IEEE80211_VIF_DISABLE_SMPS_OVERRIDE = BIT(4), 1769 }; 1770 1771 1772 /** 1773 * enum ieee80211_offload_flags - virtual interface offload flags 1774 * 1775 * @IEEE80211_OFFLOAD_ENCAP_ENABLED: tx encapsulation offload is enabled 1776 * The driver supports sending frames passed as 802.3 frames by mac80211. 1777 * It must also support sending 802.11 packets for the same interface. 1778 * @IEEE80211_OFFLOAD_ENCAP_4ADDR: support 4-address mode encapsulation offload 1779 * @IEEE80211_OFFLOAD_DECAP_ENABLED: rx encapsulation offload is enabled 1780 * The driver supports passing received 802.11 frames as 802.3 frames to 1781 * mac80211. 1782 */ 1783 1784 enum ieee80211_offload_flags { 1785 IEEE80211_OFFLOAD_ENCAP_ENABLED = BIT(0), 1786 IEEE80211_OFFLOAD_ENCAP_4ADDR = BIT(1), 1787 IEEE80211_OFFLOAD_DECAP_ENABLED = BIT(2), 1788 }; 1789 1790 /** 1791 * struct ieee80211_vif_cfg - interface configuration 1792 * @assoc: association status 1793 * @ibss_joined: indicates whether this station is part of an IBSS or not 1794 * @ibss_creator: indicates if a new IBSS network is being created 1795 * @ps: power-save mode (STA only). This flag is NOT affected by 1796 * offchannel/dynamic_ps operations. 1797 * @aid: association ID number, valid only when @assoc is true 1798 * @eml_cap: EML capabilities as described in P802.11be_D2.2 Figure 9-1002k. 1799 * @eml_med_sync_delay: Medium Synchronization delay as described in 1800 * P802.11be_D2.2 Figure 9-1002j. 1801 * @arp_addr_list: List of IPv4 addresses for hardware ARP filtering. The 1802 * may filter ARP queries targeted for other addresses than listed here. 1803 * The driver must allow ARP queries targeted for all address listed here 1804 * to pass through. An empty list implies no ARP queries need to pass. 1805 * @arp_addr_cnt: Number of addresses currently on the list. Note that this 1806 * may be larger than %IEEE80211_BSS_ARP_ADDR_LIST_LEN (the arp_addr_list 1807 * array size), it's up to the driver what to do in that case. 1808 * @ssid: The SSID of the current vif. Valid in AP and IBSS mode. 1809 * @ssid_len: Length of SSID given in @ssid. 1810 * @s1g: BSS is S1G BSS (affects Association Request format). 1811 * @idle: This interface is idle. There's also a global idle flag in the 1812 * hardware config which may be more appropriate depending on what 1813 * your driver/device needs to do. 1814 * @ap_addr: AP MLD address, or BSSID for non-MLO connections 1815 * (station mode only) 1816 */ 1817 struct ieee80211_vif_cfg { 1818 /* association related data */ 1819 bool assoc, ibss_joined; 1820 bool ibss_creator; 1821 bool ps; 1822 u16 aid; 1823 u16 eml_cap; 1824 u16 eml_med_sync_delay; 1825 1826 __be32 arp_addr_list[IEEE80211_BSS_ARP_ADDR_LIST_LEN]; 1827 int arp_addr_cnt; 1828 u8 ssid[IEEE80211_MAX_SSID_LEN]; 1829 size_t ssid_len; 1830 bool s1g; 1831 bool idle; 1832 u8 ap_addr[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2); 1833 }; 1834 1835 /** 1836 * struct ieee80211_vif - per-interface data 1837 * 1838 * Data in this structure is continually present for driver 1839 * use during the life of a virtual interface. 1840 * 1841 * @type: type of this virtual interface 1842 * @cfg: vif configuration, see &struct ieee80211_vif_cfg 1843 * @bss_conf: BSS configuration for this interface, either our own 1844 * or the BSS we're associated to 1845 * @link_conf: in case of MLD, the per-link BSS configuration, 1846 * indexed by link ID 1847 * @valid_links: bitmap of valid links, or 0 for non-MLO. 1848 * @active_links: The bitmap of active links, or 0 for non-MLO. 1849 * The driver shouldn't change this directly, but use the 1850 * API calls meant for that purpose. 1851 * @dormant_links: bitmap of valid but disabled links, or 0 for non-MLO. 1852 * Must be a subset of valid_links. 1853 * @addr: address of this interface 1854 * @p2p: indicates whether this AP or STA interface is a p2p 1855 * interface, i.e. a GO or p2p-sta respectively 1856 * @netdev_features: tx netdev features supported by the hardware for this 1857 * vif. mac80211 initializes this to hw->netdev_features, and the driver 1858 * can mask out specific tx features. mac80211 will handle software fixup 1859 * for masked offloads (GSO, CSUM) 1860 * @driver_flags: flags/capabilities the driver has for this interface, 1861 * these need to be set (or cleared) when the interface is added 1862 * or, if supported by the driver, the interface type is changed 1863 * at runtime, mac80211 will never touch this field 1864 * @offload_flags: hardware offload capabilities/flags for this interface. 1865 * These are initialized by mac80211 before calling .add_interface, 1866 * .change_interface or .update_vif_offload and updated by the driver 1867 * within these ops, based on supported features or runtime change 1868 * restrictions. 1869 * @hw_queue: hardware queue for each AC 1870 * @cab_queue: content-after-beacon (DTIM beacon really) queue, AP mode only 1871 * @debugfs_dir: debugfs dentry, can be used by drivers to create own per 1872 * interface debug files. Note that it will be NULL for the virtual 1873 * monitor interface (if that is requested.) 1874 * @probe_req_reg: probe requests should be reported to mac80211 for this 1875 * interface. 1876 * @rx_mcast_action_reg: multicast Action frames should be reported to mac80211 1877 * for this interface. 1878 * @drv_priv: data area for driver use, will always be aligned to 1879 * sizeof(void \*). 1880 * @txq: the multicast data TX queue 1881 * @offload_flags: 802.3 -> 802.11 enapsulation offload flags, see 1882 * &enum ieee80211_offload_flags. 1883 * @mbssid_tx_vif: Pointer to the transmitting interface if MBSSID is enabled. 1884 */ 1885 struct ieee80211_vif { 1886 enum nl80211_iftype type; 1887 struct ieee80211_vif_cfg cfg; 1888 struct ieee80211_bss_conf bss_conf; 1889 struct ieee80211_bss_conf __rcu *link_conf[IEEE80211_MLD_MAX_NUM_LINKS]; 1890 u16 valid_links, active_links, dormant_links; 1891 u8 addr[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2); 1892 bool p2p; 1893 1894 u8 cab_queue; 1895 u8 hw_queue[IEEE80211_NUM_ACS]; 1896 1897 struct ieee80211_txq *txq; 1898 1899 netdev_features_t netdev_features; 1900 u32 driver_flags; 1901 u32 offload_flags; 1902 1903 #ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_DEBUGFS 1904 struct dentry *debugfs_dir; 1905 #endif 1906 1907 bool probe_req_reg; 1908 bool rx_mcast_action_reg; 1909 1910 struct ieee80211_vif *mbssid_tx_vif; 1911 1912 /* must be last */ 1913 u8 drv_priv[] __aligned(sizeof(void *)); 1914 }; 1915 1916 /** 1917 * ieee80211_vif_usable_links - Return the usable links for the vif 1918 * @vif: the vif for which the usable links are requested 1919 * Return: the usable link bitmap 1920 */ 1921 static inline u16 ieee80211_vif_usable_links(const struct ieee80211_vif *vif) 1922 { 1923 return vif->valid_links & ~vif->dormant_links; 1924 } 1925 1926 /** 1927 * ieee80211_vif_is_mld - Returns true iff the vif is an MLD one 1928 * @vif: the vif 1929 * Return: %true if the vif is an MLD, %false otherwise. 1930 */ 1931 static inline bool ieee80211_vif_is_mld(const struct ieee80211_vif *vif) 1932 { 1933 /* valid_links != 0 indicates this vif is an MLD */ 1934 return vif->valid_links != 0; 1935 } 1936 1937 #define for_each_vif_active_link(vif, link, link_id) \ 1938 for (link_id = 0; link_id < ARRAY_SIZE((vif)->link_conf); link_id++) \ 1939 if ((!(vif)->active_links || \ 1940 (vif)->active_links & BIT(link_id)) && \ 1941 (link = rcu_dereference((vif)->link_conf[link_id]))) 1942 1943 static inline bool ieee80211_vif_is_mesh(struct ieee80211_vif *vif) 1944 { 1945 #ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_MESH 1946 return vif->type == NL80211_IFTYPE_MESH_POINT; 1947 #endif 1948 return false; 1949 } 1950 1951 /** 1952 * wdev_to_ieee80211_vif - return a vif struct from a wdev 1953 * @wdev: the wdev to get the vif for 1954 * 1955 * This can be used by mac80211 drivers with direct cfg80211 APIs 1956 * (like the vendor commands) that get a wdev. 1957 * 1958 * Note that this function may return %NULL if the given wdev isn't 1959 * associated with a vif that the driver knows about (e.g. monitor 1960 * or AP_VLAN interfaces.) 1961 */ 1962 struct ieee80211_vif *wdev_to_ieee80211_vif(struct wireless_dev *wdev); 1963 1964 /** 1965 * ieee80211_vif_to_wdev - return a wdev struct from a vif 1966 * @vif: the vif to get the wdev for 1967 * 1968 * This can be used by mac80211 drivers with direct cfg80211 APIs 1969 * (like the vendor commands) that needs to get the wdev for a vif. 1970 * This can also be useful to get the netdev associated to a vif. 1971 */ 1972 struct wireless_dev *ieee80211_vif_to_wdev(struct ieee80211_vif *vif); 1973 1974 /** 1975 * lockdep_vif_mutex_held - for lockdep checks on link poiners 1976 * @vif: the interface to check 1977 */ 1978 static inline bool lockdep_vif_mutex_held(struct ieee80211_vif *vif) 1979 { 1980 return lockdep_is_held(&ieee80211_vif_to_wdev(vif)->mtx); 1981 } 1982 1983 #define link_conf_dereference_protected(vif, link_id) \ 1984 rcu_dereference_protected((vif)->link_conf[link_id], \ 1985 lockdep_vif_mutex_held(vif)) 1986 1987 #define link_conf_dereference_check(vif, link_id) \ 1988 rcu_dereference_check((vif)->link_conf[link_id], \ 1989 lockdep_vif_mutex_held(vif)) 1990 1991 /** 1992 * enum ieee80211_key_flags - key flags 1993 * 1994 * These flags are used for communication about keys between the driver 1995 * and mac80211, with the @flags parameter of &struct ieee80211_key_conf. 1996 * 1997 * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_IV: This flag should be set by the 1998 * driver to indicate that it requires IV generation for this 1999 * particular key. Setting this flag does not necessarily mean that SKBs 2000 * will have sufficient tailroom for ICV or MIC. 2001 * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_MMIC: This flag should be set by 2002 * the driver for a TKIP key if it requires Michael MIC 2003 * generation in software. 2004 * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_PAIRWISE: Set by mac80211, this flag indicates 2005 * that the key is pairwise rather then a shared key. 2006 * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_SW_MGMT_TX: This flag should be set by the driver for a 2007 * CCMP/GCMP key if it requires CCMP/GCMP encryption of management frames 2008 * (MFP) to be done in software. 2009 * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_PUT_IV_SPACE: This flag should be set by the driver 2010 * if space should be prepared for the IV, but the IV 2011 * itself should not be generated. Do not set together with 2012 * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_IV on the same key. Setting this flag does 2013 * not necessarily mean that SKBs will have sufficient tailroom for ICV or 2014 * MIC. 2015 * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_RX_MGMT: This key will be used to decrypt received 2016 * management frames. The flag can help drivers that have a hardware 2017 * crypto implementation that doesn't deal with management frames 2018 * properly by allowing them to not upload the keys to hardware and 2019 * fall back to software crypto. Note that this flag deals only with 2020 * RX, if your crypto engine can't deal with TX you can also set the 2021 * %IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_SW_MGMT_TX flag to encrypt such frames in SW. 2022 * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_IV_MGMT: This flag should be set by the 2023 * driver for a CCMP/GCMP key to indicate that is requires IV generation 2024 * only for management frames (MFP). 2025 * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_RESERVE_TAILROOM: This flag should be set by the 2026 * driver for a key to indicate that sufficient tailroom must always 2027 * be reserved for ICV or MIC, even when HW encryption is enabled. 2028 * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_PUT_MIC_SPACE: This flag should be set by the driver for 2029 * a TKIP key if it only requires MIC space. Do not set together with 2030 * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_MMIC on the same key. 2031 * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_NO_AUTO_TX: Key needs explicit Tx activation. 2032 * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_MMIE: This flag should be set by the driver 2033 * for a AES_CMAC key to indicate that it requires sequence number 2034 * generation only 2035 */ 2036 enum ieee80211_key_flags { 2037 IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_IV_MGMT = BIT(0), 2038 IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_IV = BIT(1), 2039 IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_MMIC = BIT(2), 2040 IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_PAIRWISE = BIT(3), 2041 IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_SW_MGMT_TX = BIT(4), 2042 IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_PUT_IV_SPACE = BIT(5), 2043 IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_RX_MGMT = BIT(6), 2044 IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_RESERVE_TAILROOM = BIT(7), 2045 IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_PUT_MIC_SPACE = BIT(8), 2046 IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_NO_AUTO_TX = BIT(9), 2047 IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_MMIE = BIT(10), 2048 }; 2049 2050 /** 2051 * struct ieee80211_key_conf - key information 2052 * 2053 * This key information is given by mac80211 to the driver by 2054 * the set_key() callback in &struct ieee80211_ops. 2055 * 2056 * @hw_key_idx: To be set by the driver, this is the key index the driver 2057 * wants to be given when a frame is transmitted and needs to be 2058 * encrypted in hardware. 2059 * @cipher: The key's cipher suite selector. 2060 * @tx_pn: PN used for TX keys, may be used by the driver as well if it 2061 * needs to do software PN assignment by itself (e.g. due to TSO) 2062 * @flags: key flags, see &enum ieee80211_key_flags. 2063 * @keyidx: the key index (0-3) 2064 * @keylen: key material length 2065 * @key: key material. For ALG_TKIP the key is encoded as a 256-bit (32 byte) 2066 * data block: 2067 * - Temporal Encryption Key (128 bits) 2068 * - Temporal Authenticator Tx MIC Key (64 bits) 2069 * - Temporal Authenticator Rx MIC Key (64 bits) 2070 * @icv_len: The ICV length for this key type 2071 * @iv_len: The IV length for this key type 2072 * @link_id: the link ID for MLO, or -1 for non-MLO or pairwise keys 2073 */ 2074 struct ieee80211_key_conf { 2075 atomic64_t tx_pn; 2076 u32 cipher; 2077 u8 icv_len; 2078 u8 iv_len; 2079 u8 hw_key_idx; 2080 s8 keyidx; 2081 u16 flags; 2082 s8 link_id; 2083 u8 keylen; 2084 u8 key[]; 2085 }; 2086 2087 #define IEEE80211_MAX_PN_LEN 16 2088 2089 #define TKIP_PN_TO_IV16(pn) ((u16)(pn & 0xffff)) 2090 #define TKIP_PN_TO_IV32(pn) ((u32)((pn >> 16) & 0xffffffff)) 2091 2092 /** 2093 * struct ieee80211_key_seq - key sequence counter 2094 * 2095 * @tkip: TKIP data, containing IV32 and IV16 in host byte order 2096 * @ccmp: PN data, most significant byte first (big endian, 2097 * reverse order than in packet) 2098 * @aes_cmac: PN data, most significant byte first (big endian, 2099 * reverse order than in packet) 2100 * @aes_gmac: PN data, most significant byte first (big endian, 2101 * reverse order than in packet) 2102 * @gcmp: PN data, most significant byte first (big endian, 2103 * reverse order than in packet) 2104 * @hw: data for HW-only (e.g. cipher scheme) keys 2105 */ 2106 struct ieee80211_key_seq { 2107 union { 2108 struct { 2109 u32 iv32; 2110 u16 iv16; 2111 } tkip; 2112 struct { 2113 u8 pn[6]; 2114 } ccmp; 2115 struct { 2116 u8 pn[6]; 2117 } aes_cmac; 2118 struct { 2119 u8 pn[6]; 2120 } aes_gmac; 2121 struct { 2122 u8 pn[6]; 2123 } gcmp; 2124 struct { 2125 u8 seq[IEEE80211_MAX_PN_LEN]; 2126 u8 seq_len; 2127 } hw; 2128 }; 2129 }; 2130 2131 /** 2132 * enum set_key_cmd - key command 2133 * 2134 * Used with the set_key() callback in &struct ieee80211_ops, this 2135 * indicates whether a key is being removed or added. 2136 * 2137 * @SET_KEY: a key is set 2138 * @DISABLE_KEY: a key must be disabled 2139 */ 2140 enum set_key_cmd { 2141 SET_KEY, DISABLE_KEY, 2142 }; 2143 2144 /** 2145 * enum ieee80211_sta_state - station state 2146 * 2147 * @IEEE80211_STA_NOTEXIST: station doesn't exist at all, 2148 * this is a special state for add/remove transitions 2149 * @IEEE80211_STA_NONE: station exists without special state 2150 * @IEEE80211_STA_AUTH: station is authenticated 2151 * @IEEE80211_STA_ASSOC: station is associated 2152 * @IEEE80211_STA_AUTHORIZED: station is authorized (802.1X) 2153 */ 2154 enum ieee80211_sta_state { 2155 /* NOTE: These need to be ordered correctly! */ 2156 IEEE80211_STA_NOTEXIST, 2157 IEEE80211_STA_NONE, 2158 IEEE80211_STA_AUTH, 2159 IEEE80211_STA_ASSOC, 2160 IEEE80211_STA_AUTHORIZED, 2161 }; 2162 2163 /** 2164 * enum ieee80211_sta_rx_bandwidth - station RX bandwidth 2165 * @IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_20: station can only receive 20 MHz 2166 * @IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_40: station can receive up to 40 MHz 2167 * @IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_80: station can receive up to 80 MHz 2168 * @IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_160: station can receive up to 160 MHz 2169 * (including 80+80 MHz) 2170 * @IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_320: station can receive up to 320 MHz 2171 * 2172 * Implementation note: 20 must be zero to be initialized 2173 * correctly, the values must be sorted. 2174 */ 2175 enum ieee80211_sta_rx_bandwidth { 2176 IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_20 = 0, 2177 IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_40, 2178 IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_80, 2179 IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_160, 2180 IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_320, 2181 }; 2182 2183 /** 2184 * struct ieee80211_sta_rates - station rate selection table 2185 * 2186 * @rcu_head: RCU head used for freeing the table on update 2187 * @rate: transmit rates/flags to be used by default. 2188 * Overriding entries per-packet is possible by using cb tx control. 2189 */ 2190 struct ieee80211_sta_rates { 2191 struct rcu_head rcu_head; 2192 struct { 2193 s8 idx; 2194 u8 count; 2195 u8 count_cts; 2196 u8 count_rts; 2197 u16 flags; 2198 } rate[IEEE80211_TX_RATE_TABLE_SIZE]; 2199 }; 2200 2201 /** 2202 * struct ieee80211_sta_txpwr - station txpower configuration 2203 * 2204 * Used to configure txpower for station. 2205 * 2206 * @power: indicates the tx power, in dBm, to be used when sending data frames 2207 * to the STA. 2208 * @type: In particular if TPC %type is NL80211_TX_POWER_LIMITED then tx power 2209 * will be less than or equal to specified from userspace, whereas if TPC 2210 * %type is NL80211_TX_POWER_AUTOMATIC then it indicates default tx power. 2211 * NL80211_TX_POWER_FIXED is not a valid configuration option for 2212 * per peer TPC. 2213 */ 2214 struct ieee80211_sta_txpwr { 2215 s16 power; 2216 enum nl80211_tx_power_setting type; 2217 }; 2218 2219 /** 2220 * struct ieee80211_sta_aggregates - info that is aggregated from active links 2221 * 2222 * Used for any per-link data that needs to be aggregated and updated in the 2223 * main &struct ieee80211_sta when updated or the active links change. 2224 * 2225 * @max_amsdu_len: indicates the maximal length of an A-MSDU in bytes. 2226 * This field is always valid for packets with a VHT preamble. 2227 * For packets with a HT preamble, additional limits apply: 2228 * 2229 * * If the skb is transmitted as part of a BA agreement, the 2230 * A-MSDU maximal size is min(max_amsdu_len, 4065) bytes. 2231 * * If the skb is not part of a BA agreement, the A-MSDU maximal 2232 * size is min(max_amsdu_len, 7935) bytes. 2233 * 2234 * Both additional HT limits must be enforced by the low level 2235 * driver. This is defined by the spec (IEEE 802.11-2012 section 2236 * 8.3.2.2 NOTE 2). 2237 * @max_rc_amsdu_len: Maximum A-MSDU size in bytes recommended by rate control. 2238 * @max_tid_amsdu_len: Maximum A-MSDU size in bytes for this TID 2239 */ 2240 struct ieee80211_sta_aggregates { 2241 u16 max_amsdu_len; 2242 2243 u16 max_rc_amsdu_len; 2244 u16 max_tid_amsdu_len[IEEE80211_NUM_TIDS]; 2245 }; 2246 2247 /** 2248 * struct ieee80211_link_sta - station Link specific info 2249 * All link specific info for a STA link for a non MLD STA(single) 2250 * or a MLD STA(multiple entries) are stored here. 2251 * 2252 * @sta: reference to owning STA 2253 * @addr: MAC address of the Link STA. For non-MLO STA this is same as the addr 2254 * in ieee80211_sta. For MLO Link STA this addr can be same or different 2255 * from addr in ieee80211_sta (representing MLD STA addr) 2256 * @link_id: the link ID for this link STA (0 for deflink) 2257 * @smps_mode: current SMPS mode (off, static or dynamic) 2258 * @supp_rates: Bitmap of supported rates 2259 * @ht_cap: HT capabilities of this STA; restricted to our own capabilities 2260 * @vht_cap: VHT capabilities of this STA; restricted to our own capabilities 2261 * @he_cap: HE capabilities of this STA 2262 * @he_6ghz_capa: on 6 GHz, holds the HE 6 GHz band capabilities 2263 * @eht_cap: EHT capabilities of this STA 2264 * @agg: per-link data for multi-link aggregation 2265 * @bandwidth: current bandwidth the station can receive with 2266 * @rx_nss: in HT/VHT, the maximum number of spatial streams the 2267 * station can receive at the moment, changed by operating mode 2268 * notifications and capabilities. The value is only valid after 2269 * the station moves to associated state. 2270 * @txpwr: the station tx power configuration 2271 * 2272 */ 2273 struct ieee80211_link_sta { 2274 struct ieee80211_sta *sta; 2275 2276 u8 addr[ETH_ALEN]; 2277 u8 link_id; 2278 enum ieee80211_smps_mode smps_mode; 2279 2280 u32 supp_rates[NUM_NL80211_BANDS]; 2281 struct ieee80211_sta_ht_cap ht_cap; 2282 struct ieee80211_sta_vht_cap vht_cap; 2283 struct ieee80211_sta_he_cap he_cap; 2284 struct ieee80211_he_6ghz_capa he_6ghz_capa; 2285 struct ieee80211_sta_eht_cap eht_cap; 2286 2287 struct ieee80211_sta_aggregates agg; 2288 2289 u8 rx_nss; 2290 enum ieee80211_sta_rx_bandwidth bandwidth; 2291 struct ieee80211_sta_txpwr txpwr; 2292 }; 2293 2294 /** 2295 * struct ieee80211_sta - station table entry 2296 * 2297 * A station table entry represents a station we are possibly 2298 * communicating with. Since stations are RCU-managed in 2299 * mac80211, any ieee80211_sta pointer you get access to must 2300 * either be protected by rcu_read_lock() explicitly or implicitly, 2301 * or you must take good care to not use such a pointer after a 2302 * call to your sta_remove callback that removed it. 2303 * This also represents the MLD STA in case of MLO association 2304 * and holds pointers to various link STA's 2305 * 2306 * @addr: MAC address 2307 * @aid: AID we assigned to the station if we're an AP 2308 * @max_rx_aggregation_subframes: maximal amount of frames in a single AMPDU 2309 * that this station is allowed to transmit to us. 2310 * Can be modified by driver. 2311 * @wme: indicates whether the STA supports QoS/WME (if local devices does, 2312 * otherwise always false) 2313 * @drv_priv: data area for driver use, will always be aligned to 2314 * sizeof(void \*), size is determined in hw information. 2315 * @uapsd_queues: bitmap of queues configured for uapsd. Only valid 2316 * if wme is supported. The bits order is like in 2317 * IEEE80211_WMM_IE_STA_QOSINFO_AC_*. 2318 * @max_sp: max Service Period. Only valid if wme is supported. 2319 * @rates: rate control selection table 2320 * @tdls: indicates whether the STA is a TDLS peer 2321 * @tdls_initiator: indicates the STA is an initiator of the TDLS link. Only 2322 * valid if the STA is a TDLS peer in the first place. 2323 * @mfp: indicates whether the STA uses management frame protection or not. 2324 * @mlo: indicates whether the STA is MLO station. 2325 * @max_amsdu_subframes: indicates the maximal number of MSDUs in a single 2326 * A-MSDU. Taken from the Extended Capabilities element. 0 means 2327 * unlimited. 2328 * @cur: currently valid data as aggregated from the active links 2329 * For non MLO STA it will point to the deflink data. For MLO STA 2330 * ieee80211_sta_recalc_aggregates() must be called to update it. 2331 * @support_p2p_ps: indicates whether the STA supports P2P PS mechanism or not. 2332 * @txq: per-TID data TX queues; note that the last entry (%IEEE80211_NUM_TIDS) 2333 * is used for non-data frames 2334 * @deflink: This holds the default link STA information, for non MLO STA all link 2335 * specific STA information is accessed through @deflink or through 2336 * link[0] which points to address of @deflink. For MLO Link STA 2337 * the first added link STA will point to deflink. 2338 * @link: reference to Link Sta entries. For Non MLO STA, except 1st link, 2339 * i.e link[0] all links would be assigned to NULL by default and 2340 * would access link information via @deflink or link[0]. For MLO 2341 * STA, first link STA being added will point its link pointer to 2342 * @deflink address and remaining would be allocated and the address 2343 * would be assigned to link[link_id] where link_id is the id assigned 2344 * by the AP. 2345 * @valid_links: bitmap of valid links, or 0 for non-MLO 2346 */ 2347 struct ieee80211_sta { 2348 u8 addr[ETH_ALEN]; 2349 u16 aid; 2350 u16 max_rx_aggregation_subframes; 2351 bool wme; 2352 u8 uapsd_queues; 2353 u8 max_sp; 2354 struct ieee80211_sta_rates __rcu *rates; 2355 bool tdls; 2356 bool tdls_initiator; 2357 bool mfp; 2358 bool mlo; 2359 u8 max_amsdu_subframes; 2360 2361 struct ieee80211_sta_aggregates *cur; 2362 2363 bool support_p2p_ps; 2364 2365 struct ieee80211_txq *txq[IEEE80211_NUM_TIDS + 1]; 2366 2367 u16 valid_links; 2368 struct ieee80211_link_sta deflink; 2369 struct ieee80211_link_sta __rcu *link[IEEE80211_MLD_MAX_NUM_LINKS]; 2370 2371 /* must be last */ 2372 u8 drv_priv[] __aligned(sizeof(void *)); 2373 }; 2374 2375 #ifdef CONFIG_LOCKDEP 2376 bool lockdep_sta_mutex_held(struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta); 2377 #else 2378 static inline bool lockdep_sta_mutex_held(struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta) 2379 { 2380 return true; 2381 } 2382 #endif 2383 2384 #define link_sta_dereference_protected(sta, link_id) \ 2385 rcu_dereference_protected((sta)->link[link_id], \ 2386 lockdep_sta_mutex_held(sta)) 2387 2388 #define link_sta_dereference_check(sta, link_id) \ 2389 rcu_dereference_check((sta)->link[link_id], \ 2390 lockdep_sta_mutex_held(sta)) 2391 2392 #define for_each_sta_active_link(vif, sta, link_sta, link_id) \ 2393 for (link_id = 0; link_id < ARRAY_SIZE((sta)->link); link_id++) \ 2394 if ((!(vif)->active_links || \ 2395 (vif)->active_links & BIT(link_id)) && \ 2396 ((link_sta) = link_sta_dereference_protected(sta, link_id))) 2397 2398 /** 2399 * enum sta_notify_cmd - sta notify command 2400 * 2401 * Used with the sta_notify() callback in &struct ieee80211_ops, this 2402 * indicates if an associated station made a power state transition. 2403 * 2404 * @STA_NOTIFY_SLEEP: a station is now sleeping 2405 * @STA_NOTIFY_AWAKE: a sleeping station woke up 2406 */ 2407 enum sta_notify_cmd { 2408 STA_NOTIFY_SLEEP, STA_NOTIFY_AWAKE, 2409 }; 2410 2411 /** 2412 * struct ieee80211_tx_control - TX control data 2413 * 2414 * @sta: station table entry, this sta pointer may be NULL and 2415 * it is not allowed to copy the pointer, due to RCU. 2416 */ 2417 struct ieee80211_tx_control { 2418 struct ieee80211_sta *sta; 2419 }; 2420 2421 /** 2422 * struct ieee80211_txq - Software intermediate tx queue 2423 * 2424 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback. 2425 * @sta: station table entry, %NULL for per-vif queue 2426 * @tid: the TID for this queue (unused for per-vif queue), 2427 * %IEEE80211_NUM_TIDS for non-data (if enabled) 2428 * @ac: the AC for this queue 2429 * @drv_priv: driver private area, sized by hw->txq_data_size 2430 * 2431 * The driver can obtain packets from this queue by calling 2432 * ieee80211_tx_dequeue(). 2433 */ 2434 struct ieee80211_txq { 2435 struct ieee80211_vif *vif; 2436 struct ieee80211_sta *sta; 2437 u8 tid; 2438 u8 ac; 2439 2440 /* must be last */ 2441 u8 drv_priv[] __aligned(sizeof(void *)); 2442 }; 2443 2444 /** 2445 * enum ieee80211_hw_flags - hardware flags 2446 * 2447 * These flags are used to indicate hardware capabilities to 2448 * the stack. Generally, flags here should have their meaning 2449 * done in a way that the simplest hardware doesn't need setting 2450 * any particular flags. There are some exceptions to this rule, 2451 * however, so you are advised to review these flags carefully. 2452 * 2453 * @IEEE80211_HW_HAS_RATE_CONTROL: 2454 * The hardware or firmware includes rate control, and cannot be 2455 * controlled by the stack. As such, no rate control algorithm 2456 * should be instantiated, and the TX rate reported to userspace 2457 * will be taken from the TX status instead of the rate control 2458 * algorithm. 2459 * Note that this requires that the driver implement a number of 2460 * callbacks so it has the correct information, it needs to have 2461 * the @set_rts_threshold callback and must look at the BSS config 2462 * @use_cts_prot for G/N protection, @use_short_slot for slot 2463 * timing in 2.4 GHz and @use_short_preamble for preambles for 2464 * CCK frames. 2465 * 2466 * @IEEE80211_HW_RX_INCLUDES_FCS: 2467 * Indicates that received frames passed to the stack include 2468 * the FCS at the end. 2469 * 2470 * @IEEE80211_HW_HOST_BROADCAST_PS_BUFFERING: 2471 * Some wireless LAN chipsets buffer broadcast/multicast frames 2472 * for power saving stations in the hardware/firmware and others 2473 * rely on the host system for such buffering. This option is used 2474 * to configure the IEEE 802.11 upper layer to buffer broadcast and 2475 * multicast frames when there are power saving stations so that 2476 * the driver can fetch them with ieee80211_get_buffered_bc(). 2477 * 2478 * @IEEE80211_HW_SIGNAL_UNSPEC: 2479 * Hardware can provide signal values but we don't know its units. We 2480 * expect values between 0 and @max_signal. 2481 * If possible please provide dB or dBm instead. 2482 * 2483 * @IEEE80211_HW_SIGNAL_DBM: 2484 * Hardware gives signal values in dBm, decibel difference from 2485 * one milliwatt. This is the preferred method since it is standardized 2486 * between different devices. @max_signal does not need to be set. 2487 * 2488 * @IEEE80211_HW_SPECTRUM_MGMT: 2489 * Hardware supports spectrum management defined in 802.11h 2490 * Measurement, Channel Switch, Quieting, TPC 2491 * 2492 * @IEEE80211_HW_AMPDU_AGGREGATION: 2493 * Hardware supports 11n A-MPDU aggregation. 2494 * 2495 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_PS: 2496 * Hardware has power save support (i.e. can go to sleep). 2497 * 2498 * @IEEE80211_HW_PS_NULLFUNC_STACK: 2499 * Hardware requires nullfunc frame handling in stack, implies 2500 * stack support for dynamic PS. 2501 * 2502 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_DYNAMIC_PS: 2503 * Hardware has support for dynamic PS. 2504 * 2505 * @IEEE80211_HW_MFP_CAPABLE: 2506 * Hardware supports management frame protection (MFP, IEEE 802.11w). 2507 * 2508 * @IEEE80211_HW_REPORTS_TX_ACK_STATUS: 2509 * Hardware can provide ack status reports of Tx frames to 2510 * the stack. 2511 * 2512 * @IEEE80211_HW_CONNECTION_MONITOR: 2513 * The hardware performs its own connection monitoring, including 2514 * periodic keep-alives to the AP and probing the AP on beacon loss. 2515 * 2516 * @IEEE80211_HW_NEED_DTIM_BEFORE_ASSOC: 2517 * This device needs to get data from beacon before association (i.e. 2518 * dtim_period). 2519 * 2520 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_PER_STA_GTK: The device's crypto engine supports 2521 * per-station GTKs as used by IBSS RSN or during fast transition. If 2522 * the device doesn't support per-station GTKs, but can be asked not 2523 * to decrypt group addressed frames, then IBSS RSN support is still 2524 * possible but software crypto will be used. Advertise the wiphy flag 2525 * only in that case. 2526 * 2527 * @IEEE80211_HW_AP_LINK_PS: When operating in AP mode the device 2528 * autonomously manages the PS status of connected stations. When 2529 * this flag is set mac80211 will not trigger PS mode for connected 2530 * stations based on the PM bit of incoming frames. 2531 * Use ieee80211_start_ps()/ieee8021_end_ps() to manually configure 2532 * the PS mode of connected stations. 2533 * 2534 * @IEEE80211_HW_TX_AMPDU_SETUP_IN_HW: The device handles TX A-MPDU session 2535 * setup strictly in HW. mac80211 should not attempt to do this in 2536 * software. 2537 * 2538 * @IEEE80211_HW_WANT_MONITOR_VIF: The driver would like to be informed of 2539 * a virtual monitor interface when monitor interfaces are the only 2540 * active interfaces. 2541 * 2542 * @IEEE80211_HW_NO_AUTO_VIF: The driver would like for no wlanX to 2543 * be created. It is expected user-space will create vifs as 2544 * desired (and thus have them named as desired). 2545 * 2546 * @IEEE80211_HW_SW_CRYPTO_CONTROL: The driver wants to control which of the 2547 * crypto algorithms can be done in software - so don't automatically 2548 * try to fall back to it if hardware crypto fails, but do so only if 2549 * the driver returns 1. This also forces the driver to advertise its 2550 * supported cipher suites. 2551 * 2552 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORT_FAST_XMIT: The driver/hardware supports fast-xmit, 2553 * this currently requires only the ability to calculate the duration 2554 * for frames. 2555 * 2556 * @IEEE80211_HW_QUEUE_CONTROL: The driver wants to control per-interface 2557 * queue mapping in order to use different queues (not just one per AC) 2558 * for different virtual interfaces. See the doc section on HW queue 2559 * control for more details. 2560 * 2561 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_RC_TABLE: The driver supports using a rate 2562 * selection table provided by the rate control algorithm. 2563 * 2564 * @IEEE80211_HW_P2P_DEV_ADDR_FOR_INTF: Use the P2P Device address for any 2565 * P2P Interface. This will be honoured even if more than one interface 2566 * is supported. 2567 * 2568 * @IEEE80211_HW_TIMING_BEACON_ONLY: Use sync timing from beacon frames 2569 * only, to allow getting TBTT of a DTIM beacon. 2570 * 2571 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_HT_CCK_RATES: Hardware supports mixing HT/CCK rates 2572 * and can cope with CCK rates in an aggregation session (e.g. by not 2573 * using aggregation for such frames.) 2574 * 2575 * @IEEE80211_HW_CHANCTX_STA_CSA: Support 802.11h based channel-switch (CSA) 2576 * for a single active channel while using channel contexts. When support 2577 * is not enabled the default action is to disconnect when getting the 2578 * CSA frame. 2579 * 2580 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_CLONED_SKBS: The driver will never modify the payload 2581 * or tailroom of TX skbs without copying them first. 2582 * 2583 * @IEEE80211_HW_SINGLE_SCAN_ON_ALL_BANDS: The HW supports scanning on all bands 2584 * in one command, mac80211 doesn't have to run separate scans per band. 2585 * 2586 * @IEEE80211_HW_TDLS_WIDER_BW: The device/driver supports wider bandwidth 2587 * than then BSS bandwidth for a TDLS link on the base channel. 2588 * 2589 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_AMSDU_IN_AMPDU: The driver supports receiving A-MSDUs 2590 * within A-MPDU. 2591 * 2592 * @IEEE80211_HW_BEACON_TX_STATUS: The device/driver provides TX status 2593 * for sent beacons. 2594 * 2595 * @IEEE80211_HW_NEEDS_UNIQUE_STA_ADDR: Hardware (or driver) requires that each 2596 * station has a unique address, i.e. each station entry can be identified 2597 * by just its MAC address; this prevents, for example, the same station 2598 * from connecting to two virtual AP interfaces at the same time. 2599 * 2600 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_REORDERING_BUFFER: Hardware (or driver) manages the 2601 * reordering buffer internally, guaranteeing mac80211 receives frames in 2602 * order and does not need to manage its own reorder buffer or BA session 2603 * timeout. 2604 * 2605 * @IEEE80211_HW_USES_RSS: The device uses RSS and thus requires parallel RX, 2606 * which implies using per-CPU station statistics. 2607 * 2608 * @IEEE80211_HW_TX_AMSDU: Hardware (or driver) supports software aggregated 2609 * A-MSDU frames. Requires software tx queueing and fast-xmit support. 2610 * When not using minstrel/minstrel_ht rate control, the driver must 2611 * limit the maximum A-MSDU size based on the current tx rate by setting 2612 * max_rc_amsdu_len in struct ieee80211_sta. 2613 * 2614 * @IEEE80211_HW_TX_FRAG_LIST: Hardware (or driver) supports sending frag_list 2615 * skbs, needed for zero-copy software A-MSDU. 2616 * 2617 * @IEEE80211_HW_REPORTS_LOW_ACK: The driver (or firmware) reports low ack event 2618 * by ieee80211_report_low_ack() based on its own algorithm. For such 2619 * drivers, mac80211 packet loss mechanism will not be triggered and driver 2620 * is completely depending on firmware event for station kickout. 2621 * 2622 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_TX_FRAG: Hardware does fragmentation by itself. 2623 * The stack will not do fragmentation. 2624 * The callback for @set_frag_threshold should be set as well. 2625 * 2626 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_TDLS_BUFFER_STA: Hardware supports buffer STA on 2627 * TDLS links. 2628 * 2629 * @IEEE80211_HW_DEAUTH_NEED_MGD_TX_PREP: The driver requires the 2630 * mgd_prepare_tx() callback to be called before transmission of a 2631 * deauthentication frame in case the association was completed but no 2632 * beacon was heard. This is required in multi-channel scenarios, where the 2633 * virtual interface might not be given air time for the transmission of 2634 * the frame, as it is not synced with the AP/P2P GO yet, and thus the 2635 * deauthentication frame might not be transmitted. 2636 * 2637 * @IEEE80211_HW_DOESNT_SUPPORT_QOS_NDP: The driver (or firmware) doesn't 2638 * support QoS NDP for AP probing - that's most likely a driver bug. 2639 * 2640 * @IEEE80211_HW_BUFF_MMPDU_TXQ: use the TXQ for bufferable MMPDUs, this of 2641 * course requires the driver to use TXQs to start with. 2642 * 2643 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_VHT_EXT_NSS_BW: (Hardware) rate control supports VHT 2644 * extended NSS BW (dot11VHTExtendedNSSBWCapable). This flag will be set if 2645 * the selected rate control algorithm sets %RATE_CTRL_CAPA_VHT_EXT_NSS_BW 2646 * but if the rate control is built-in then it must be set by the driver. 2647 * See also the documentation for that flag. 2648 * 2649 * @IEEE80211_HW_STA_MMPDU_TXQ: use the extra non-TID per-station TXQ for all 2650 * MMPDUs on station interfaces. This of course requires the driver to use 2651 * TXQs to start with. 2652 * 2653 * @IEEE80211_HW_TX_STATUS_NO_AMPDU_LEN: Driver does not report accurate A-MPDU 2654 * length in tx status information 2655 * 2656 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_MULTI_BSSID: Hardware supports multi BSSID 2657 * 2658 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_ONLY_HE_MULTI_BSSID: Hardware supports multi BSSID 2659 * only for HE APs. Applies if @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_MULTI_BSSID is set. 2660 * 2661 * @IEEE80211_HW_AMPDU_KEYBORDER_SUPPORT: The card and driver is only 2662 * aggregating MPDUs with the same keyid, allowing mac80211 to keep Tx 2663 * A-MPDU sessions active while rekeying with Extended Key ID. 2664 * 2665 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_TX_ENCAP_OFFLOAD: Hardware supports tx encapsulation 2666 * offload 2667 * 2668 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_RX_DECAP_OFFLOAD: Hardware supports rx decapsulation 2669 * offload 2670 * 2671 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_CONC_MON_RX_DECAP: Hardware supports concurrent rx 2672 * decapsulation offload and passing raw 802.11 frames for monitor iface. 2673 * If this is supported, the driver must pass both 802.3 frames for real 2674 * usage and 802.11 frames with %RX_FLAG_ONLY_MONITOR set for monitor to 2675 * the stack. 2676 * 2677 * @IEEE80211_HW_DETECTS_COLOR_COLLISION: HW/driver has support for BSS color 2678 * collision detection and doesn't need it in software. 2679 * 2680 * @IEEE80211_HW_MLO_MCAST_MULTI_LINK_TX: Hardware/driver handles transmitting 2681 * multicast frames on all links, mac80211 should not do that. 2682 * 2683 * @NUM_IEEE80211_HW_FLAGS: number of hardware flags, used for sizing arrays 2684 */ 2685 enum ieee80211_hw_flags { 2686 IEEE80211_HW_HAS_RATE_CONTROL, 2687 IEEE80211_HW_RX_INCLUDES_FCS, 2688 IEEE80211_HW_HOST_BROADCAST_PS_BUFFERING, 2689 IEEE80211_HW_SIGNAL_UNSPEC, 2690 IEEE80211_HW_SIGNAL_DBM, 2691 IEEE80211_HW_NEED_DTIM_BEFORE_ASSOC, 2692 IEEE80211_HW_SPECTRUM_MGMT, 2693 IEEE80211_HW_AMPDU_AGGREGATION, 2694 IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_PS, 2695 IEEE80211_HW_PS_NULLFUNC_STACK, 2696 IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_DYNAMIC_PS, 2697 IEEE80211_HW_MFP_CAPABLE, 2698 IEEE80211_HW_WANT_MONITOR_VIF, 2699 IEEE80211_HW_NO_AUTO_VIF, 2700 IEEE80211_HW_SW_CRYPTO_CONTROL, 2701 IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORT_FAST_XMIT, 2702 IEEE80211_HW_REPORTS_TX_ACK_STATUS, 2703 IEEE80211_HW_CONNECTION_MONITOR, 2704 IEEE80211_HW_QUEUE_CONTROL, 2705 IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_PER_STA_GTK, 2706 IEEE80211_HW_AP_LINK_PS, 2707 IEEE80211_HW_TX_AMPDU_SETUP_IN_HW, 2708 IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_RC_TABLE, 2709 IEEE80211_HW_P2P_DEV_ADDR_FOR_INTF, 2710 IEEE80211_HW_TIMING_BEACON_ONLY, 2711 IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_HT_CCK_RATES, 2712 IEEE80211_HW_CHANCTX_STA_CSA, 2713 IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_CLONED_SKBS, 2714 IEEE80211_HW_SINGLE_SCAN_ON_ALL_BANDS, 2715 IEEE80211_HW_TDLS_WIDER_BW, 2716 IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_AMSDU_IN_AMPDU, 2717 IEEE80211_HW_BEACON_TX_STATUS, 2718 IEEE80211_HW_NEEDS_UNIQUE_STA_ADDR, 2719 IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_REORDERING_BUFFER, 2720 IEEE80211_HW_USES_RSS, 2721 IEEE80211_HW_TX_AMSDU, 2722 IEEE80211_HW_TX_FRAG_LIST, 2723 IEEE80211_HW_REPORTS_LOW_ACK, 2724 IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_TX_FRAG, 2725 IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_TDLS_BUFFER_STA, 2726 IEEE80211_HW_DEAUTH_NEED_MGD_TX_PREP, 2727 IEEE80211_HW_DOESNT_SUPPORT_QOS_NDP, 2728 IEEE80211_HW_BUFF_MMPDU_TXQ, 2729 IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_VHT_EXT_NSS_BW, 2730 IEEE80211_HW_STA_MMPDU_TXQ, 2731 IEEE80211_HW_TX_STATUS_NO_AMPDU_LEN, 2732 IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_MULTI_BSSID, 2733 IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_ONLY_HE_MULTI_BSSID, 2734 IEEE80211_HW_AMPDU_KEYBORDER_SUPPORT, 2735 IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_TX_ENCAP_OFFLOAD, 2736 IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_RX_DECAP_OFFLOAD, 2737 IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_CONC_MON_RX_DECAP, 2738 IEEE80211_HW_DETECTS_COLOR_COLLISION, 2739 IEEE80211_HW_MLO_MCAST_MULTI_LINK_TX, 2740 2741 /* keep last, obviously */ 2742 NUM_IEEE80211_HW_FLAGS 2743 }; 2744 2745 /** 2746 * struct ieee80211_hw - hardware information and state 2747 * 2748 * This structure contains the configuration and hardware 2749 * information for an 802.11 PHY. 2750 * 2751 * @wiphy: This points to the &struct wiphy allocated for this 2752 * 802.11 PHY. You must fill in the @perm_addr and @dev 2753 * members of this structure using SET_IEEE80211_DEV() 2754 * and SET_IEEE80211_PERM_ADDR(). Additionally, all supported 2755 * bands (with channels, bitrates) are registered here. 2756 * 2757 * @conf: &struct ieee80211_conf, device configuration, don't use. 2758 * 2759 * @priv: pointer to private area that was allocated for driver use 2760 * along with this structure. 2761 * 2762 * @flags: hardware flags, see &enum ieee80211_hw_flags. 2763 * 2764 * @extra_tx_headroom: headroom to reserve in each transmit skb 2765 * for use by the driver (e.g. for transmit headers.) 2766 * 2767 * @extra_beacon_tailroom: tailroom to reserve in each beacon tx skb. 2768 * Can be used by drivers to add extra IEs. 2769 * 2770 * @max_signal: Maximum value for signal (rssi) in RX information, used 2771 * only when @IEEE80211_HW_SIGNAL_UNSPEC or @IEEE80211_HW_SIGNAL_DB 2772 * 2773 * @max_listen_interval: max listen interval in units of beacon interval 2774 * that HW supports 2775 * 2776 * @queues: number of available hardware transmit queues for 2777 * data packets. WMM/QoS requires at least four, these 2778 * queues need to have configurable access parameters. 2779 * 2780 * @rate_control_algorithm: rate control algorithm for this hardware. 2781 * If unset (NULL), the default algorithm will be used. Must be 2782 * set before calling ieee80211_register_hw(). 2783 * 2784 * @vif_data_size: size (in bytes) of the drv_priv data area 2785 * within &struct ieee80211_vif. 2786 * @sta_data_size: size (in bytes) of the drv_priv data area 2787 * within &struct ieee80211_sta. 2788 * @chanctx_data_size: size (in bytes) of the drv_priv data area 2789 * within &struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf. 2790 * @txq_data_size: size (in bytes) of the drv_priv data area 2791 * within @struct ieee80211_txq. 2792 * 2793 * @max_rates: maximum number of alternate rate retry stages the hw 2794 * can handle. 2795 * @max_report_rates: maximum number of alternate rate retry stages 2796 * the hw can report back. 2797 * @max_rate_tries: maximum number of tries for each stage 2798 * 2799 * @max_rx_aggregation_subframes: maximum buffer size (number of 2800 * sub-frames) to be used for A-MPDU block ack receiver 2801 * aggregation. 2802 * This is only relevant if the device has restrictions on the 2803 * number of subframes, if it relies on mac80211 to do reordering 2804 * it shouldn't be set. 2805 * 2806 * @max_tx_aggregation_subframes: maximum number of subframes in an 2807 * aggregate an HT/HE device will transmit. In HT AddBA we'll 2808 * advertise a constant value of 64 as some older APs crash if 2809 * the window size is smaller (an example is LinkSys WRT120N 2810 * with FW v1.0.07 build 002 Jun 18 2012). 2811 * For AddBA to HE capable peers this value will be used. 2812 * 2813 * @max_tx_fragments: maximum number of tx buffers per (A)-MSDU, sum 2814 * of 1 + skb_shinfo(skb)->nr_frags for each skb in the frag_list. 2815 * 2816 * @offchannel_tx_hw_queue: HW queue ID to use for offchannel TX 2817 * (if %IEEE80211_HW_QUEUE_CONTROL is set) 2818 * 2819 * @radiotap_mcs_details: lists which MCS information can the HW 2820 * reports, by default it is set to _MCS, _GI and _BW but doesn't 2821 * include _FMT. Use %IEEE80211_RADIOTAP_MCS_HAVE_\* values, only 2822 * adding _BW is supported today. 2823 * 2824 * @radiotap_vht_details: lists which VHT MCS information the HW reports, 2825 * the default is _GI | _BANDWIDTH. 2826 * Use the %IEEE80211_RADIOTAP_VHT_KNOWN_\* values. 2827 * 2828 * @radiotap_he: HE radiotap validity flags 2829 * 2830 * @radiotap_timestamp: Information for the radiotap timestamp field; if the 2831 * @units_pos member is set to a non-negative value then the timestamp 2832 * field will be added and populated from the &struct ieee80211_rx_status 2833 * device_timestamp. 2834 * @radiotap_timestamp.units_pos: Must be set to a combination of a 2835 * IEEE80211_RADIOTAP_TIMESTAMP_UNIT_* and a 2836 * IEEE80211_RADIOTAP_TIMESTAMP_SPOS_* value. 2837 * @radiotap_timestamp.accuracy: If non-negative, fills the accuracy in the 2838 * radiotap field and the accuracy known flag will be set. 2839 * 2840 * @netdev_features: netdev features to be set in each netdev created 2841 * from this HW. Note that not all features are usable with mac80211, 2842 * other features will be rejected during HW registration. 2843 * 2844 * @uapsd_queues: This bitmap is included in (re)association frame to indicate 2845 * for each access category if it is uAPSD trigger-enabled and delivery- 2846 * enabled. Use IEEE80211_WMM_IE_STA_QOSINFO_AC_* to set this bitmap. 2847 * Each bit corresponds to different AC. Value '1' in specific bit means 2848 * that corresponding AC is both trigger- and delivery-enabled. '0' means 2849 * neither enabled. 2850 * 2851 * @uapsd_max_sp_len: maximum number of total buffered frames the WMM AP may 2852 * deliver to a WMM STA during any Service Period triggered by the WMM STA. 2853 * Use IEEE80211_WMM_IE_STA_QOSINFO_SP_* for correct values. 2854 * 2855 * @max_nan_de_entries: maximum number of NAN DE functions supported by the 2856 * device. 2857 * 2858 * @tx_sk_pacing_shift: Pacing shift to set on TCP sockets when frames from 2859 * them are encountered. The default should typically not be changed, 2860 * unless the driver has good reasons for needing more buffers. 2861 * 2862 * @weight_multiplier: Driver specific airtime weight multiplier used while 2863 * refilling deficit of each TXQ. 2864 * 2865 * @max_mtu: the max mtu could be set. 2866 * 2867 * @tx_power_levels: a list of power levels supported by the wifi hardware. 2868 * The power levels can be specified either as integer or fractions. 2869 * The power level at idx 0 shall be the maximum positive power level. 2870 * 2871 * @max_txpwr_levels_idx: the maximum valid idx of 'tx_power_levels' list. 2872 */ 2873 struct ieee80211_hw { 2874 struct ieee80211_conf conf; 2875 struct wiphy *wiphy; 2876 const char *rate_control_algorithm; 2877 void *priv; 2878 unsigned long flags[BITS_TO_LONGS(NUM_IEEE80211_HW_FLAGS)]; 2879 unsigned int extra_tx_headroom; 2880 unsigned int extra_beacon_tailroom; 2881 int vif_data_size; 2882 int sta_data_size; 2883 int chanctx_data_size; 2884 int txq_data_size; 2885 u16 queues; 2886 u16 max_listen_interval; 2887 s8 max_signal; 2888 u8 max_rates; 2889 u8 max_report_rates; 2890 u8 max_rate_tries; 2891 u16 max_rx_aggregation_subframes; 2892 u16 max_tx_aggregation_subframes; 2893 u8 max_tx_fragments; 2894 u8 offchannel_tx_hw_queue; 2895 u8 radiotap_mcs_details; 2896 u16 radiotap_vht_details; 2897 struct { 2898 int units_pos; 2899 s16 accuracy; 2900 } radiotap_timestamp; 2901 netdev_features_t netdev_features; 2902 u8 uapsd_queues; 2903 u8 uapsd_max_sp_len; 2904 u8 max_nan_de_entries; 2905 u8 tx_sk_pacing_shift; 2906 u8 weight_multiplier; 2907 u32 max_mtu; 2908 const s8 *tx_power_levels; 2909 u8 max_txpwr_levels_idx; 2910 }; 2911 2912 static inline bool _ieee80211_hw_check(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 2913 enum ieee80211_hw_flags flg) 2914 { 2915 return test_bit(flg, hw->flags); 2916 } 2917 #define ieee80211_hw_check(hw, flg) _ieee80211_hw_check(hw, IEEE80211_HW_##flg) 2918 2919 static inline void _ieee80211_hw_set(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 2920 enum ieee80211_hw_flags flg) 2921 { 2922 return __set_bit(flg, hw->flags); 2923 } 2924 #define ieee80211_hw_set(hw, flg) _ieee80211_hw_set(hw, IEEE80211_HW_##flg) 2925 2926 /** 2927 * struct ieee80211_scan_request - hw scan request 2928 * 2929 * @ies: pointers different parts of IEs (in req.ie) 2930 * @req: cfg80211 request. 2931 */ 2932 struct ieee80211_scan_request { 2933 struct ieee80211_scan_ies ies; 2934 2935 /* Keep last */ 2936 struct cfg80211_scan_request req; 2937 }; 2938 2939 /** 2940 * struct ieee80211_tdls_ch_sw_params - TDLS channel switch parameters 2941 * 2942 * @sta: peer this TDLS channel-switch request/response came from 2943 * @chandef: channel referenced in a TDLS channel-switch request 2944 * @action_code: see &enum ieee80211_tdls_actioncode 2945 * @status: channel-switch response status 2946 * @timestamp: time at which the frame was received 2947 * @switch_time: switch-timing parameter received in the frame 2948 * @switch_timeout: switch-timing parameter received in the frame 2949 * @tmpl_skb: TDLS switch-channel response template 2950 * @ch_sw_tm_ie: offset of the channel-switch timing IE inside @tmpl_skb 2951 */ 2952 struct ieee80211_tdls_ch_sw_params { 2953 struct ieee80211_sta *sta; 2954 struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef; 2955 u8 action_code; 2956 u32 status; 2957 u32 timestamp; 2958 u16 switch_time; 2959 u16 switch_timeout; 2960 struct sk_buff *tmpl_skb; 2961 u32 ch_sw_tm_ie; 2962 }; 2963 2964 /** 2965 * wiphy_to_ieee80211_hw - return a mac80211 driver hw struct from a wiphy 2966 * 2967 * @wiphy: the &struct wiphy which we want to query 2968 * 2969 * mac80211 drivers can use this to get to their respective 2970 * &struct ieee80211_hw. Drivers wishing to get to their own private 2971 * structure can then access it via hw->priv. Note that mac802111 drivers should 2972 * not use wiphy_priv() to try to get their private driver structure as this 2973 * is already used internally by mac80211. 2974 * 2975 * Return: The mac80211 driver hw struct of @wiphy. 2976 */ 2977 struct ieee80211_hw *wiphy_to_ieee80211_hw(struct wiphy *wiphy); 2978 2979 /** 2980 * SET_IEEE80211_DEV - set device for 802.11 hardware 2981 * 2982 * @hw: the &struct ieee80211_hw to set the device for 2983 * @dev: the &struct device of this 802.11 device 2984 */ 2985 static inline void SET_IEEE80211_DEV(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct device *dev) 2986 { 2987 set_wiphy_dev(hw->wiphy, dev); 2988 } 2989 2990 /** 2991 * SET_IEEE80211_PERM_ADDR - set the permanent MAC address for 802.11 hardware 2992 * 2993 * @hw: the &struct ieee80211_hw to set the MAC address for 2994 * @addr: the address to set 2995 */ 2996 static inline void SET_IEEE80211_PERM_ADDR(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, const u8 *addr) 2997 { 2998 memcpy(hw->wiphy->perm_addr, addr, ETH_ALEN); 2999 } 3000 3001 static inline struct ieee80211_rate * 3002 ieee80211_get_tx_rate(const struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 3003 const struct ieee80211_tx_info *c) 3004 { 3005 if (WARN_ON_ONCE(c->control.rates[0].idx < 0)) 3006 return NULL; 3007 return &hw->wiphy->bands[c->band]->bitrates[c->control.rates[0].idx]; 3008 } 3009 3010 static inline struct ieee80211_rate * 3011 ieee80211_get_rts_cts_rate(const struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 3012 const struct ieee80211_tx_info *c) 3013 { 3014 if (c->control.rts_cts_rate_idx < 0) 3015 return NULL; 3016 return &hw->wiphy->bands[c->band]->bitrates[c->control.rts_cts_rate_idx]; 3017 } 3018 3019 static inline struct ieee80211_rate * 3020 ieee80211_get_alt_retry_rate(const struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 3021 const struct ieee80211_tx_info *c, int idx) 3022 { 3023 if (c->control.rates[idx + 1].idx < 0) 3024 return NULL; 3025 return &hw->wiphy->bands[c->band]->bitrates[c->control.rates[idx + 1].idx]; 3026 } 3027 3028 /** 3029 * ieee80211_free_txskb - free TX skb 3030 * @hw: the hardware 3031 * @skb: the skb 3032 * 3033 * Free a transmit skb. Use this function when some failure 3034 * to transmit happened and thus status cannot be reported. 3035 */ 3036 void ieee80211_free_txskb(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct sk_buff *skb); 3037 3038 /** 3039 * DOC: Hardware crypto acceleration 3040 * 3041 * mac80211 is capable of taking advantage of many hardware 3042 * acceleration designs for encryption and decryption operations. 3043 * 3044 * The set_key() callback in the &struct ieee80211_ops for a given 3045 * device is called to enable hardware acceleration of encryption and 3046 * decryption. The callback takes a @sta parameter that will be NULL 3047 * for default keys or keys used for transmission only, or point to 3048 * the station information for the peer for individual keys. 3049 * Multiple transmission keys with the same key index may be used when 3050 * VLANs are configured for an access point. 3051 * 3052 * When transmitting, the TX control data will use the @hw_key_idx 3053 * selected by the driver by modifying the &struct ieee80211_key_conf 3054 * pointed to by the @key parameter to the set_key() function. 3055 * 3056 * The set_key() call for the %SET_KEY command should return 0 if 3057 * the key is now in use, -%EOPNOTSUPP or -%ENOSPC if it couldn't be 3058 * added; if you return 0 then hw_key_idx must be assigned to the 3059 * hardware key index, you are free to use the full u8 range. 3060 * 3061 * Note that in the case that the @IEEE80211_HW_SW_CRYPTO_CONTROL flag is 3062 * set, mac80211 will not automatically fall back to software crypto if 3063 * enabling hardware crypto failed. The set_key() call may also return the 3064 * value 1 to permit this specific key/algorithm to be done in software. 3065 * 3066 * When the cmd is %DISABLE_KEY then it must succeed. 3067 * 3068 * Note that it is permissible to not decrypt a frame even if a key 3069 * for it has been uploaded to hardware, the stack will not make any 3070 * decision based on whether a key has been uploaded or not but rather 3071 * based on the receive flags. 3072 * 3073 * The &struct ieee80211_key_conf structure pointed to by the @key 3074 * parameter is guaranteed to be valid until another call to set_key() 3075 * removes it, but it can only be used as a cookie to differentiate 3076 * keys. 3077 * 3078 * In TKIP some HW need to be provided a phase 1 key, for RX decryption 3079 * acceleration (i.e. iwlwifi). Those drivers should provide update_tkip_key 3080 * handler. 3081 * The update_tkip_key() call updates the driver with the new phase 1 key. 3082 * This happens every time the iv16 wraps around (every 65536 packets). The 3083 * set_key() call will happen only once for each key (unless the AP did 3084 * rekeying), it will not include a valid phase 1 key. The valid phase 1 key is 3085 * provided by update_tkip_key only. The trigger that makes mac80211 call this 3086 * handler is software decryption with wrap around of iv16. 3087 * 3088 * The set_default_unicast_key() call updates the default WEP key index 3089 * configured to the hardware for WEP encryption type. This is required 3090 * for devices that support offload of data packets (e.g. ARP responses). 3091 * 3092 * Mac80211 drivers should set the @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_CAN_REPLACE_PTK0 flag 3093 * when they are able to replace in-use PTK keys according to the following 3094 * requirements: 3095 * 1) They do not hand over frames decrypted with the old key to mac80211 3096 once the call to set_key() with command %DISABLE_KEY has been completed, 3097 2) either drop or continue to use the old key for any outgoing frames queued 3098 at the time of the key deletion (including re-transmits), 3099 3) never send out a frame queued prior to the set_key() %SET_KEY command 3100 encrypted with the new key when also needing 3101 @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_IV and 3102 4) never send out a frame unencrypted when it should be encrypted. 3103 Mac80211 will not queue any new frames for a deleted key to the driver. 3104 */ 3105 3106 /** 3107 * DOC: Powersave support 3108 * 3109 * mac80211 has support for various powersave implementations. 3110 * 3111 * First, it can support hardware that handles all powersaving by itself, 3112 * such hardware should simply set the %IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_PS hardware 3113 * flag. In that case, it will be told about the desired powersave mode 3114 * with the %IEEE80211_CONF_PS flag depending on the association status. 3115 * The hardware must take care of sending nullfunc frames when necessary, 3116 * i.e. when entering and leaving powersave mode. The hardware is required 3117 * to look at the AID in beacons and signal to the AP that it woke up when 3118 * it finds traffic directed to it. 3119 * 3120 * %IEEE80211_CONF_PS flag enabled means that the powersave mode defined in 3121 * IEEE 802.11-2007 section 11.2 is enabled. This is not to be confused 3122 * with hardware wakeup and sleep states. Driver is responsible for waking 3123 * up the hardware before issuing commands to the hardware and putting it 3124 * back to sleep at appropriate times. 3125 * 3126 * When PS is enabled, hardware needs to wakeup for beacons and receive the 3127 * buffered multicast/broadcast frames after the beacon. Also it must be 3128 * possible to send frames and receive the acknowledment frame. 3129 * 3130 * Other hardware designs cannot send nullfunc frames by themselves and also 3131 * need software support for parsing the TIM bitmap. This is also supported 3132 * by mac80211 by combining the %IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_PS and 3133 * %IEEE80211_HW_PS_NULLFUNC_STACK flags. The hardware is of course still 3134 * required to pass up beacons. The hardware is still required to handle 3135 * waking up for multicast traffic; if it cannot the driver must handle that 3136 * as best as it can, mac80211 is too slow to do that. 3137 * 3138 * Dynamic powersave is an extension to normal powersave in which the 3139 * hardware stays awake for a user-specified period of time after sending a 3140 * frame so that reply frames need not be buffered and therefore delayed to 3141 * the next wakeup. It's compromise of getting good enough latency when 3142 * there's data traffic and still saving significantly power in idle 3143 * periods. 3144 * 3145 * Dynamic powersave is simply supported by mac80211 enabling and disabling 3146 * PS based on traffic. Driver needs to only set %IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_PS 3147 * flag and mac80211 will handle everything automatically. Additionally, 3148 * hardware having support for the dynamic PS feature may set the 3149 * %IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_DYNAMIC_PS flag to indicate that it can support 3150 * dynamic PS mode itself. The driver needs to look at the 3151 * @dynamic_ps_timeout hardware configuration value and use it that value 3152 * whenever %IEEE80211_CONF_PS is set. In this case mac80211 will disable 3153 * dynamic PS feature in stack and will just keep %IEEE80211_CONF_PS 3154 * enabled whenever user has enabled powersave. 3155 * 3156 * Driver informs U-APSD client support by enabling 3157 * %IEEE80211_VIF_SUPPORTS_UAPSD flag. The mode is configured through the 3158 * uapsd parameter in conf_tx() operation. Hardware needs to send the QoS 3159 * Nullfunc frames and stay awake until the service period has ended. To 3160 * utilize U-APSD, dynamic powersave is disabled for voip AC and all frames 3161 * from that AC are transmitted with powersave enabled. 3162 * 3163 * Note: U-APSD client mode is not yet supported with 3164 * %IEEE80211_HW_PS_NULLFUNC_STACK. 3165 */ 3166 3167 /** 3168 * DOC: Beacon filter support 3169 * 3170 * Some hardware have beacon filter support to reduce host cpu wakeups 3171 * which will reduce system power consumption. It usually works so that 3172 * the firmware creates a checksum of the beacon but omits all constantly 3173 * changing elements (TSF, TIM etc). Whenever the checksum changes the 3174 * beacon is forwarded to the host, otherwise it will be just dropped. That 3175 * way the host will only receive beacons where some relevant information 3176 * (for example ERP protection or WMM settings) have changed. 3177 * 3178 * Beacon filter support is advertised with the %IEEE80211_VIF_BEACON_FILTER 3179 * interface capability. The driver needs to enable beacon filter support 3180 * whenever power save is enabled, that is %IEEE80211_CONF_PS is set. When 3181 * power save is enabled, the stack will not check for beacon loss and the 3182 * driver needs to notify about loss of beacons with ieee80211_beacon_loss(). 3183 * 3184 * The time (or number of beacons missed) until the firmware notifies the 3185 * driver of a beacon loss event (which in turn causes the driver to call 3186 * ieee80211_beacon_loss()) should be configurable and will be controlled 3187 * by mac80211 and the roaming algorithm in the future. 3188 * 3189 * Since there may be constantly changing information elements that nothing 3190 * in the software stack cares about, we will, in the future, have mac80211 3191 * tell the driver which information elements are interesting in the sense 3192 * that we want to see changes in them. This will include 3193 * 3194 * - a list of information element IDs 3195 * - a list of OUIs for the vendor information element 3196 * 3197 * Ideally, the hardware would filter out any beacons without changes in the 3198 * requested elements, but if it cannot support that it may, at the expense 3199 * of some efficiency, filter out only a subset. For example, if the device 3200 * doesn't support checking for OUIs it should pass up all changes in all 3201 * vendor information elements. 3202 * 3203 * Note that change, for the sake of simplification, also includes information 3204 * elements appearing or disappearing from the beacon. 3205 * 3206 * Some hardware supports an "ignore list" instead, just make sure nothing 3207 * that was requested is on the ignore list, and include commonly changing 3208 * information element IDs in the ignore list, for example 11 (BSS load) and 3209 * the various vendor-assigned IEs with unknown contents (128, 129, 133-136, 3210 * 149, 150, 155, 156, 173, 176, 178, 179, 219); for forward compatibility 3211 * it could also include some currently unused IDs. 3212 * 3213 * 3214 * In addition to these capabilities, hardware should support notifying the 3215 * host of changes in the beacon RSSI. This is relevant to implement roaming 3216 * when no traffic is flowing (when traffic is flowing we see the RSSI of 3217 * the received data packets). This can consist in notifying the host when 3218 * the RSSI changes significantly or when it drops below or rises above 3219 * configurable thresholds. In the future these thresholds will also be 3220 * configured by mac80211 (which gets them from userspace) to implement 3221 * them as the roaming algorithm requires. 3222 * 3223 * If the hardware cannot implement this, the driver should ask it to 3224 * periodically pass beacon frames to the host so that software can do the 3225 * signal strength threshold checking. 3226 */ 3227 3228 /** 3229 * DOC: Spatial multiplexing power save 3230 * 3231 * SMPS (Spatial multiplexing power save) is a mechanism to conserve 3232 * power in an 802.11n implementation. For details on the mechanism 3233 * and rationale, please refer to 802.11 (as amended by 802.11n-2009) 3234 * "11.2.3 SM power save". 3235 * 3236 * The mac80211 implementation is capable of sending action frames 3237 * to update the AP about the station's SMPS mode, and will instruct 3238 * the driver to enter the specific mode. It will also announce the 3239 * requested SMPS mode during the association handshake. Hardware 3240 * support for this feature is required, and can be indicated by 3241 * hardware flags. 3242 * 3243 * The default mode will be "automatic", which nl80211/cfg80211 3244 * defines to be dynamic SMPS in (regular) powersave, and SMPS 3245 * turned off otherwise. 3246 * 3247 * To support this feature, the driver must set the appropriate 3248 * hardware support flags, and handle the SMPS flag to the config() 3249 * operation. It will then with this mechanism be instructed to 3250 * enter the requested SMPS mode while associated to an HT AP. 3251 */ 3252 3253 /** 3254 * DOC: Frame filtering 3255 * 3256 * mac80211 requires to see many management frames for proper 3257 * operation, and users may want to see many more frames when 3258 * in monitor mode. However, for best CPU usage and power consumption, 3259 * having as few frames as possible percolate through the stack is 3260 * desirable. Hence, the hardware should filter as much as possible. 3261 * 3262 * To achieve this, mac80211 uses filter flags (see below) to tell 3263 * the driver's configure_filter() function which frames should be 3264 * passed to mac80211 and which should be filtered out. 3265 * 3266 * Before configure_filter() is invoked, the prepare_multicast() 3267 * callback is invoked with the parameters @mc_count and @mc_list 3268 * for the combined multicast address list of all virtual interfaces. 3269 * It's use is optional, and it returns a u64 that is passed to 3270 * configure_filter(). Additionally, configure_filter() has the 3271 * arguments @changed_flags telling which flags were changed and 3272 * @total_flags with the new flag states. 3273 * 3274 * If your device has no multicast address filters your driver will 3275 * need to check both the %FIF_ALLMULTI flag and the @mc_count 3276 * parameter to see whether multicast frames should be accepted 3277 * or dropped. 3278 * 3279 * All unsupported flags in @total_flags must be cleared. 3280 * Hardware does not support a flag if it is incapable of _passing_ 3281 * the frame to the stack. Otherwise the driver must ignore 3282 * the flag, but not clear it. 3283 * You must _only_ clear the flag (announce no support for the 3284 * flag to mac80211) if you are not able to pass the packet type 3285 * to the stack (so the hardware always filters it). 3286 * So for example, you should clear @FIF_CONTROL, if your hardware 3287 * always filters control frames. If your hardware always passes 3288 * control frames to the kernel and is incapable of filtering them, 3289 * you do _not_ clear the @FIF_CONTROL flag. 3290 * This rule applies to all other FIF flags as well. 3291 */ 3292 3293 /** 3294 * DOC: AP support for powersaving clients 3295 * 3296 * In order to implement AP and P2P GO modes, mac80211 has support for 3297 * client powersaving, both "legacy" PS (PS-Poll/null data) and uAPSD. 3298 * There currently is no support for sAPSD. 3299 * 3300 * There is one assumption that mac80211 makes, namely that a client 3301 * will not poll with PS-Poll and trigger with uAPSD at the same time. 3302 * Both are supported, and both can be used by the same client, but 3303 * they can't be used concurrently by the same client. This simplifies 3304 * the driver code. 3305 * 3306 * The first thing to keep in mind is that there is a flag for complete 3307 * driver implementation: %IEEE80211_HW_AP_LINK_PS. If this flag is set, 3308 * mac80211 expects the driver to handle most of the state machine for 3309 * powersaving clients and will ignore the PM bit in incoming frames. 3310 * Drivers then use ieee80211_sta_ps_transition() to inform mac80211 of 3311 * stations' powersave transitions. In this mode, mac80211 also doesn't 3312 * handle PS-Poll/uAPSD. 3313 * 3314 * In the mode without %IEEE80211_HW_AP_LINK_PS, mac80211 will check the 3315 * PM bit in incoming frames for client powersave transitions. When a 3316 * station goes to sleep, we will stop transmitting to it. There is, 3317 * however, a race condition: a station might go to sleep while there is 3318 * data buffered on hardware queues. If the device has support for this 3319 * it will reject frames, and the driver should give the frames back to 3320 * mac80211 with the %IEEE80211_TX_STAT_TX_FILTERED flag set which will 3321 * cause mac80211 to retry the frame when the station wakes up. The 3322 * driver is also notified of powersave transitions by calling its 3323 * @sta_notify callback. 3324 * 3325 * When the station is asleep, it has three choices: it can wake up, 3326 * it can PS-Poll, or it can possibly start a uAPSD service period. 3327 * Waking up is implemented by simply transmitting all buffered (and 3328 * filtered) frames to the station. This is the easiest case. When 3329 * the station sends a PS-Poll or a uAPSD trigger frame, mac80211 3330 * will inform the driver of this with the @allow_buffered_frames 3331 * callback; this callback is optional. mac80211 will then transmit 3332 * the frames as usual and set the %IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_PS_BUFFER 3333 * on each frame. The last frame in the service period (or the only 3334 * response to a PS-Poll) also has %IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP set to 3335 * indicate that it ends the service period; as this frame must have 3336 * TX status report it also sets %IEEE80211_TX_CTL_REQ_TX_STATUS. 3337 * When TX status is reported for this frame, the service period is 3338 * marked has having ended and a new one can be started by the peer. 3339 * 3340 * Additionally, non-bufferable MMPDUs can also be transmitted by 3341 * mac80211 with the %IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_PS_BUFFER set in them. 3342 * 3343 * Another race condition can happen on some devices like iwlwifi 3344 * when there are frames queued for the station and it wakes up 3345 * or polls; the frames that are already queued could end up being 3346 * transmitted first instead, causing reordering and/or wrong 3347 * processing of the EOSP. The cause is that allowing frames to be 3348 * transmitted to a certain station is out-of-band communication to 3349 * the device. To allow this problem to be solved, the driver can 3350 * call ieee80211_sta_block_awake() if frames are buffered when it 3351 * is notified that the station went to sleep. When all these frames 3352 * have been filtered (see above), it must call the function again 3353 * to indicate that the station is no longer blocked. 3354 * 3355 * If the driver buffers frames in the driver for aggregation in any 3356 * way, it must use the ieee80211_sta_set_buffered() call when it is 3357 * notified of the station going to sleep to inform mac80211 of any 3358 * TIDs that have frames buffered. Note that when a station wakes up 3359 * this information is reset (hence the requirement to call it when 3360 * informed of the station going to sleep). Then, when a service 3361 * period starts for any reason, @release_buffered_frames is called 3362 * with the number of frames to be released and which TIDs they are 3363 * to come from. In this case, the driver is responsible for setting 3364 * the EOSP (for uAPSD) and MORE_DATA bits in the released frames, 3365 * to help the @more_data parameter is passed to tell the driver if 3366 * there is more data on other TIDs -- the TIDs to release frames 3367 * from are ignored since mac80211 doesn't know how many frames the 3368 * buffers for those TIDs contain. 3369 * 3370 * If the driver also implement GO mode, where absence periods may 3371 * shorten service periods (or abort PS-Poll responses), it must 3372 * filter those response frames except in the case of frames that 3373 * are buffered in the driver -- those must remain buffered to avoid 3374 * reordering. Because it is possible that no frames are released 3375 * in this case, the driver must call ieee80211_sta_eosp() 3376 * to indicate to mac80211 that the service period ended anyway. 3377 * 3378 * Finally, if frames from multiple TIDs are released from mac80211 3379 * but the driver might reorder them, it must clear & set the flags 3380 * appropriately (only the last frame may have %IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP) 3381 * and also take care of the EOSP and MORE_DATA bits in the frame. 3382 * The driver may also use ieee80211_sta_eosp() in this case. 3383 * 3384 * Note that if the driver ever buffers frames other than QoS-data 3385 * frames, it must take care to never send a non-QoS-data frame as 3386 * the last frame in a service period, adding a QoS-nulldata frame 3387 * after a non-QoS-data frame if needed. 3388 */ 3389 3390 /** 3391 * DOC: HW queue control 3392 * 3393 * Before HW queue control was introduced, mac80211 only had a single static 3394 * assignment of per-interface AC software queues to hardware queues. This 3395 * was problematic for a few reasons: 3396 * 1) off-channel transmissions might get stuck behind other frames 3397 * 2) multiple virtual interfaces couldn't be handled correctly 3398 * 3) after-DTIM frames could get stuck behind other frames 3399 * 3400 * To solve this, hardware typically uses multiple different queues for all 3401 * the different usages, and this needs to be propagated into mac80211 so it 3402 * won't have the same problem with the software queues. 3403 * 3404 * Therefore, mac80211 now offers the %IEEE80211_HW_QUEUE_CONTROL capability 3405 * flag that tells it that the driver implements its own queue control. To do 3406 * so, the driver will set up the various queues in each &struct ieee80211_vif 3407 * and the offchannel queue in &struct ieee80211_hw. In response, mac80211 will 3408 * use those queue IDs in the hw_queue field of &struct ieee80211_tx_info and 3409 * if necessary will queue the frame on the right software queue that mirrors 3410 * the hardware queue. 3411 * Additionally, the driver has to then use these HW queue IDs for the queue 3412 * management functions (ieee80211_stop_queue() et al.) 3413 * 3414 * The driver is free to set up the queue mappings as needed, multiple virtual 3415 * interfaces may map to the same hardware queues if needed. The setup has to 3416 * happen during add_interface or change_interface callbacks. For example, a 3417 * driver supporting station+station and station+AP modes might decide to have 3418 * 10 hardware queues to handle different scenarios: 3419 * 3420 * 4 AC HW queues for 1st vif: 0, 1, 2, 3 3421 * 4 AC HW queues for 2nd vif: 4, 5, 6, 7 3422 * after-DTIM queue for AP: 8 3423 * off-channel queue: 9 3424 * 3425 * It would then set up the hardware like this: 3426 * hw.offchannel_tx_hw_queue = 9 3427 * 3428 * and the first virtual interface that is added as follows: 3429 * vif.hw_queue[IEEE80211_AC_VO] = 0 3430 * vif.hw_queue[IEEE80211_AC_VI] = 1 3431 * vif.hw_queue[IEEE80211_AC_BE] = 2 3432 * vif.hw_queue[IEEE80211_AC_BK] = 3 3433 * vif.cab_queue = 8 // if AP mode, otherwise %IEEE80211_INVAL_HW_QUEUE 3434 * and the second virtual interface with 4-7. 3435 * 3436 * If queue 6 gets full, for example, mac80211 would only stop the second 3437 * virtual interface's BE queue since virtual interface queues are per AC. 3438 * 3439 * Note that the vif.cab_queue value should be set to %IEEE80211_INVAL_HW_QUEUE 3440 * whenever the queue is not used (i.e. the interface is not in AP mode) if the 3441 * queue could potentially be shared since mac80211 will look at cab_queue when 3442 * a queue is stopped/woken even if the interface is not in AP mode. 3443 */ 3444 3445 /** 3446 * enum ieee80211_filter_flags - hardware filter flags 3447 * 3448 * These flags determine what the filter in hardware should be 3449 * programmed to let through and what should not be passed to the 3450 * stack. It is always safe to pass more frames than requested, 3451 * but this has negative impact on power consumption. 3452 * 3453 * @FIF_ALLMULTI: pass all multicast frames, this is used if requested 3454 * by the user or if the hardware is not capable of filtering by 3455 * multicast address. 3456 * 3457 * @FIF_FCSFAIL: pass frames with failed FCS (but you need to set the 3458 * %RX_FLAG_FAILED_FCS_CRC for them) 3459 * 3460 * @FIF_PLCPFAIL: pass frames with failed PLCP CRC (but you need to set 3461 * the %RX_FLAG_FAILED_PLCP_CRC for them 3462 * 3463 * @FIF_BCN_PRBRESP_PROMISC: This flag is set during scanning to indicate 3464 * to the hardware that it should not filter beacons or probe responses 3465 * by BSSID. Filtering them can greatly reduce the amount of processing 3466 * mac80211 needs to do and the amount of CPU wakeups, so you should 3467 * honour this flag if possible. 3468 * 3469 * @FIF_CONTROL: pass control frames (except for PS Poll) addressed to this 3470 * station 3471 * 3472 * @FIF_OTHER_BSS: pass frames destined to other BSSes 3473 * 3474 * @FIF_PSPOLL: pass PS Poll frames 3475 * 3476 * @FIF_PROBE_REQ: pass probe request frames 3477 * 3478 * @FIF_MCAST_ACTION: pass multicast Action frames 3479 */ 3480 enum ieee80211_filter_flags { 3481 FIF_ALLMULTI = 1<<1, 3482 FIF_FCSFAIL = 1<<2, 3483 FIF_PLCPFAIL = 1<<3, 3484 FIF_BCN_PRBRESP_PROMISC = 1<<4, 3485 FIF_CONTROL = 1<<5, 3486 FIF_OTHER_BSS = 1<<6, 3487 FIF_PSPOLL = 1<<7, 3488 FIF_PROBE_REQ = 1<<8, 3489 FIF_MCAST_ACTION = 1<<9, 3490 }; 3491 3492 /** 3493 * enum ieee80211_ampdu_mlme_action - A-MPDU actions 3494 * 3495 * These flags are used with the ampdu_action() callback in 3496 * &struct ieee80211_ops to indicate which action is needed. 3497 * 3498 * Note that drivers MUST be able to deal with a TX aggregation 3499 * session being stopped even before they OK'ed starting it by 3500 * calling ieee80211_start_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe, because the peer 3501 * might receive the addBA frame and send a delBA right away! 3502 * 3503 * @IEEE80211_AMPDU_RX_START: start RX aggregation 3504 * @IEEE80211_AMPDU_RX_STOP: stop RX aggregation 3505 * @IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_START: start TX aggregation, the driver must either 3506 * call ieee80211_start_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe() or 3507 * call ieee80211_start_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe() with status 3508 * %IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_START_DELAY_ADDBA to delay addba after 3509 * ieee80211_start_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe is called, or just return the special 3510 * status %IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_START_IMMEDIATE. 3511 * @IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_OPERATIONAL: TX aggregation has become operational 3512 * @IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_STOP_CONT: stop TX aggregation but continue transmitting 3513 * queued packets, now unaggregated. After all packets are transmitted the 3514 * driver has to call ieee80211_stop_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe(). 3515 * @IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_STOP_FLUSH: stop TX aggregation and flush all packets, 3516 * called when the station is removed. There's no need or reason to call 3517 * ieee80211_stop_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe() in this case as mac80211 assumes the 3518 * session is gone and removes the station. 3519 * @IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_STOP_FLUSH_CONT: called when TX aggregation is stopped 3520 * but the driver hasn't called ieee80211_stop_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe() yet and 3521 * now the connection is dropped and the station will be removed. Drivers 3522 * should clean up and drop remaining packets when this is called. 3523 */ 3524 enum ieee80211_ampdu_mlme_action { 3525 IEEE80211_AMPDU_RX_START, 3526 IEEE80211_AMPDU_RX_STOP, 3527 IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_START, 3528 IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_STOP_CONT, 3529 IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_STOP_FLUSH, 3530 IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_STOP_FLUSH_CONT, 3531 IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_OPERATIONAL, 3532 }; 3533 3534 #define IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_START_IMMEDIATE 1 3535 #define IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_START_DELAY_ADDBA 2 3536 3537 /** 3538 * struct ieee80211_ampdu_params - AMPDU action parameters 3539 * 3540 * @action: the ampdu action, value from %ieee80211_ampdu_mlme_action. 3541 * @sta: peer of this AMPDU session 3542 * @tid: tid of the BA session 3543 * @ssn: start sequence number of the session. TX/RX_STOP can pass 0. When 3544 * action is set to %IEEE80211_AMPDU_RX_START the driver passes back the 3545 * actual ssn value used to start the session and writes the value here. 3546 * @buf_size: reorder buffer size (number of subframes). Valid only when the 3547 * action is set to %IEEE80211_AMPDU_RX_START or 3548 * %IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_OPERATIONAL 3549 * @amsdu: indicates the peer's ability to receive A-MSDU within A-MPDU. 3550 * valid when the action is set to %IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_OPERATIONAL 3551 * @timeout: BA session timeout. Valid only when the action is set to 3552 * %IEEE80211_AMPDU_RX_START 3553 */ 3554 struct ieee80211_ampdu_params { 3555 enum ieee80211_ampdu_mlme_action action; 3556 struct ieee80211_sta *sta; 3557 u16 tid; 3558 u16 ssn; 3559 u16 buf_size; 3560 bool amsdu; 3561 u16 timeout; 3562 }; 3563 3564 /** 3565 * enum ieee80211_frame_release_type - frame release reason 3566 * @IEEE80211_FRAME_RELEASE_PSPOLL: frame released for PS-Poll 3567 * @IEEE80211_FRAME_RELEASE_UAPSD: frame(s) released due to 3568 * frame received on trigger-enabled AC 3569 */ 3570 enum ieee80211_frame_release_type { 3571 IEEE80211_FRAME_RELEASE_PSPOLL, 3572 IEEE80211_FRAME_RELEASE_UAPSD, 3573 }; 3574 3575 /** 3576 * enum ieee80211_rate_control_changed - flags to indicate what changed 3577 * 3578 * @IEEE80211_RC_BW_CHANGED: The bandwidth that can be used to transmit 3579 * to this station changed. The actual bandwidth is in the station 3580 * information -- for HT20/40 the IEEE80211_HT_CAP_SUP_WIDTH_20_40 3581 * flag changes, for HT and VHT the bandwidth field changes. 3582 * @IEEE80211_RC_SMPS_CHANGED: The SMPS state of the station changed. 3583 * @IEEE80211_RC_SUPP_RATES_CHANGED: The supported rate set of this peer 3584 * changed (in IBSS mode) due to discovering more information about 3585 * the peer. 3586 * @IEEE80211_RC_NSS_CHANGED: N_SS (number of spatial streams) was changed 3587 * by the peer 3588 */ 3589 enum ieee80211_rate_control_changed { 3590 IEEE80211_RC_BW_CHANGED = BIT(0), 3591 IEEE80211_RC_SMPS_CHANGED = BIT(1), 3592 IEEE80211_RC_SUPP_RATES_CHANGED = BIT(2), 3593 IEEE80211_RC_NSS_CHANGED = BIT(3), 3594 }; 3595 3596 /** 3597 * enum ieee80211_roc_type - remain on channel type 3598 * 3599 * With the support for multi channel contexts and multi channel operations, 3600 * remain on channel operations might be limited/deferred/aborted by other 3601 * flows/operations which have higher priority (and vice versa). 3602 * Specifying the ROC type can be used by devices to prioritize the ROC 3603 * operations compared to other operations/flows. 3604 * 3605 * @IEEE80211_ROC_TYPE_NORMAL: There are no special requirements for this ROC. 3606 * @IEEE80211_ROC_TYPE_MGMT_TX: The remain on channel request is required 3607 * for sending management frames offchannel. 3608 */ 3609 enum ieee80211_roc_type { 3610 IEEE80211_ROC_TYPE_NORMAL = 0, 3611 IEEE80211_ROC_TYPE_MGMT_TX, 3612 }; 3613 3614 /** 3615 * enum ieee80211_reconfig_type - reconfig type 3616 * 3617 * This enum is used by the reconfig_complete() callback to indicate what 3618 * reconfiguration type was completed. 3619 * 3620 * @IEEE80211_RECONFIG_TYPE_RESTART: hw restart type 3621 * (also due to resume() callback returning 1) 3622 * @IEEE80211_RECONFIG_TYPE_SUSPEND: suspend type (regardless 3623 * of wowlan configuration) 3624 */ 3625 enum ieee80211_reconfig_type { 3626 IEEE80211_RECONFIG_TYPE_RESTART, 3627 IEEE80211_RECONFIG_TYPE_SUSPEND, 3628 }; 3629 3630 /** 3631 * struct ieee80211_prep_tx_info - prepare TX information 3632 * @duration: if non-zero, hint about the required duration, 3633 * only used with the mgd_prepare_tx() method. 3634 * @subtype: frame subtype (auth, (re)assoc, deauth, disassoc) 3635 * @success: whether the frame exchange was successful, only 3636 * used with the mgd_complete_tx() method, and then only 3637 * valid for auth and (re)assoc. 3638 */ 3639 struct ieee80211_prep_tx_info { 3640 u16 duration; 3641 u16 subtype; 3642 u8 success:1; 3643 }; 3644 3645 /** 3646 * struct ieee80211_ops - callbacks from mac80211 to the driver 3647 * 3648 * This structure contains various callbacks that the driver may 3649 * handle or, in some cases, must handle, for example to configure 3650 * the hardware to a new channel or to transmit a frame. 3651 * 3652 * @tx: Handler that 802.11 module calls for each transmitted frame. 3653 * skb contains the buffer starting from the IEEE 802.11 header. 3654 * The low-level driver should send the frame out based on 3655 * configuration in the TX control data. This handler should, 3656 * preferably, never fail and stop queues appropriately. 3657 * Must be atomic. 3658 * 3659 * @start: Called before the first netdevice attached to the hardware 3660 * is enabled. This should turn on the hardware and must turn on 3661 * frame reception (for possibly enabled monitor interfaces.) 3662 * Returns negative error codes, these may be seen in userspace, 3663 * or zero. 3664 * When the device is started it should not have a MAC address 3665 * to avoid acknowledging frames before a non-monitor device 3666 * is added. 3667 * Must be implemented and can sleep. 3668 * 3669 * @stop: Called after last netdevice attached to the hardware 3670 * is disabled. This should turn off the hardware (at least 3671 * it must turn off frame reception.) 3672 * May be called right after add_interface if that rejects 3673 * an interface. If you added any work onto the mac80211 workqueue 3674 * you should ensure to cancel it on this callback. 3675 * Must be implemented and can sleep. 3676 * 3677 * @suspend: Suspend the device; mac80211 itself will quiesce before and 3678 * stop transmitting and doing any other configuration, and then 3679 * ask the device to suspend. This is only invoked when WoWLAN is 3680 * configured, otherwise the device is deconfigured completely and 3681 * reconfigured at resume time. 3682 * The driver may also impose special conditions under which it 3683 * wants to use the "normal" suspend (deconfigure), say if it only 3684 * supports WoWLAN when the device is associated. In this case, it 3685 * must return 1 from this function. 3686 * 3687 * @resume: If WoWLAN was configured, this indicates that mac80211 is 3688 * now resuming its operation, after this the device must be fully 3689 * functional again. If this returns an error, the only way out is 3690 * to also unregister the device. If it returns 1, then mac80211 3691 * will also go through the regular complete restart on resume. 3692 * 3693 * @set_wakeup: Enable or disable wakeup when WoWLAN configuration is 3694 * modified. The reason is that device_set_wakeup_enable() is 3695 * supposed to be called when the configuration changes, not only 3696 * in suspend(). 3697 * 3698 * @add_interface: Called when a netdevice attached to the hardware is 3699 * enabled. Because it is not called for monitor mode devices, @start 3700 * and @stop must be implemented. 3701 * The driver should perform any initialization it needs before 3702 * the device can be enabled. The initial configuration for the 3703 * interface is given in the conf parameter. 3704 * The callback may refuse to add an interface by returning a 3705 * negative error code (which will be seen in userspace.) 3706 * Must be implemented and can sleep. 3707 * 3708 * @change_interface: Called when a netdevice changes type. This callback 3709 * is optional, but only if it is supported can interface types be 3710 * switched while the interface is UP. The callback may sleep. 3711 * Note that while an interface is being switched, it will not be 3712 * found by the interface iteration callbacks. 3713 * 3714 * @remove_interface: Notifies a driver that an interface is going down. 3715 * The @stop callback is called after this if it is the last interface 3716 * and no monitor interfaces are present. 3717 * When all interfaces are removed, the MAC address in the hardware 3718 * must be cleared so the device no longer acknowledges packets, 3719 * the mac_addr member of the conf structure is, however, set to the 3720 * MAC address of the device going away. 3721 * Hence, this callback must be implemented. It can sleep. 3722 * 3723 * @config: Handler for configuration requests. IEEE 802.11 code calls this 3724 * function to change hardware configuration, e.g., channel. 3725 * This function should never fail but returns a negative error code 3726 * if it does. The callback can sleep. 3727 * 3728 * @bss_info_changed: Handler for configuration requests related to BSS 3729 * parameters that may vary during BSS's lifespan, and may affect low 3730 * level driver (e.g. assoc/disassoc status, erp parameters). 3731 * This function should not be used if no BSS has been set, unless 3732 * for association indication. The @changed parameter indicates which 3733 * of the bss parameters has changed when a call is made. The callback 3734 * can sleep. 3735 * Note: this callback is called if @vif_cfg_changed or @link_info_changed 3736 * are not implemented. 3737 * 3738 * @vif_cfg_changed: Handler for configuration requests related to interface 3739 * (MLD) parameters from &struct ieee80211_vif_cfg that vary during the 3740 * lifetime of the interface (e.g. assoc status, IP addresses, etc.) 3741 * The @changed parameter indicates which value changed. 3742 * The callback can sleep. 3743 * 3744 * @link_info_changed: Handler for configuration requests related to link 3745 * parameters from &struct ieee80211_bss_conf that are related to an 3746 * individual link. e.g. legacy/HT/VHT/... rate information. 3747 * The @changed parameter indicates which value changed, and the @link_id 3748 * parameter indicates the link ID. Note that the @link_id will be 0 for 3749 * non-MLO connections. 3750 * The callback can sleep. 3751 * 3752 * @prepare_multicast: Prepare for multicast filter configuration. 3753 * This callback is optional, and its return value is passed 3754 * to configure_filter(). This callback must be atomic. 3755 * 3756 * @configure_filter: Configure the device's RX filter. 3757 * See the section "Frame filtering" for more information. 3758 * This callback must be implemented and can sleep. 3759 * 3760 * @config_iface_filter: Configure the interface's RX filter. 3761 * This callback is optional and is used to configure which frames 3762 * should be passed to mac80211. The filter_flags is the combination 3763 * of FIF_* flags. The changed_flags is a bit mask that indicates 3764 * which flags are changed. 3765 * This callback can sleep. 3766 * 3767 * @set_tim: Set TIM bit. mac80211 calls this function when a TIM bit 3768 * must be set or cleared for a given STA. Must be atomic. 3769 * 3770 * @set_key: See the section "Hardware crypto acceleration" 3771 * This callback is only called between add_interface and 3772 * remove_interface calls, i.e. while the given virtual interface 3773 * is enabled. 3774 * Returns a negative error code if the key can't be added. 3775 * The callback can sleep. 3776 * 3777 * @update_tkip_key: See the section "Hardware crypto acceleration" 3778 * This callback will be called in the context of Rx. Called for drivers 3779 * which set IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_TKIP_REQ_RX_P1_KEY. 3780 * The callback must be atomic. 3781 * 3782 * @set_rekey_data: If the device supports GTK rekeying, for example while the 3783 * host is suspended, it can assign this callback to retrieve the data 3784 * necessary to do GTK rekeying, this is the KEK, KCK and replay counter. 3785 * After rekeying was done it should (for example during resume) notify 3786 * userspace of the new replay counter using ieee80211_gtk_rekey_notify(). 3787 * 3788 * @set_default_unicast_key: Set the default (unicast) key index, useful for 3789 * WEP when the device sends data packets autonomously, e.g. for ARP 3790 * offloading. The index can be 0-3, or -1 for unsetting it. 3791 * 3792 * @hw_scan: Ask the hardware to service the scan request, no need to start 3793 * the scan state machine in stack. The scan must honour the channel 3794 * configuration done by the regulatory agent in the wiphy's 3795 * registered bands. The hardware (or the driver) needs to make sure 3796 * that power save is disabled. 3797 * The @req ie/ie_len members are rewritten by mac80211 to contain the 3798 * entire IEs after the SSID, so that drivers need not look at these 3799 * at all but just send them after the SSID -- mac80211 includes the 3800 * (extended) supported rates and HT information (where applicable). 3801 * When the scan finishes, ieee80211_scan_completed() must be called; 3802 * note that it also must be called when the scan cannot finish due to 3803 * any error unless this callback returned a negative error code. 3804 * This callback is also allowed to return the special return value 1, 3805 * this indicates that hardware scan isn't desirable right now and a 3806 * software scan should be done instead. A driver wishing to use this 3807 * capability must ensure its (hardware) scan capabilities aren't 3808 * advertised as more capable than mac80211's software scan is. 3809 * The callback can sleep. 3810 * 3811 * @cancel_hw_scan: Ask the low-level tp cancel the active hw scan. 3812 * The driver should ask the hardware to cancel the scan (if possible), 3813 * but the scan will be completed only after the driver will call 3814 * ieee80211_scan_completed(). 3815 * This callback is needed for wowlan, to prevent enqueueing a new 3816 * scan_work after the low-level driver was already suspended. 3817 * The callback can sleep. 3818 * 3819 * @sched_scan_start: Ask the hardware to start scanning repeatedly at 3820 * specific intervals. The driver must call the 3821 * ieee80211_sched_scan_results() function whenever it finds results. 3822 * This process will continue until sched_scan_stop is called. 3823 * 3824 * @sched_scan_stop: Tell the hardware to stop an ongoing scheduled scan. 3825 * In this case, ieee80211_sched_scan_stopped() must not be called. 3826 * 3827 * @sw_scan_start: Notifier function that is called just before a software scan 3828 * is started. Can be NULL, if the driver doesn't need this notification. 3829 * The mac_addr parameter allows supporting NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_RANDOM_ADDR, 3830 * the driver may set the NL80211_FEATURE_SCAN_RANDOM_MAC_ADDR flag if it 3831 * can use this parameter. The callback can sleep. 3832 * 3833 * @sw_scan_complete: Notifier function that is called just after a 3834 * software scan finished. Can be NULL, if the driver doesn't need 3835 * this notification. 3836 * The callback can sleep. 3837 * 3838 * @get_stats: Return low-level statistics. 3839 * Returns zero if statistics are available. 3840 * The callback can sleep. 3841 * 3842 * @get_key_seq: If your device implements encryption in hardware and does 3843 * IV/PN assignment then this callback should be provided to read the 3844 * IV/PN for the given key from hardware. 3845 * The callback must be atomic. 3846 * 3847 * @set_frag_threshold: Configuration of fragmentation threshold. Assign this 3848 * if the device does fragmentation by itself. Note that to prevent the 3849 * stack from doing fragmentation IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_TX_FRAG 3850 * should be set as well. 3851 * The callback can sleep. 3852 * 3853 * @set_rts_threshold: Configuration of RTS threshold (if device needs it) 3854 * The callback can sleep. 3855 * 3856 * @sta_add: Notifies low level driver about addition of an associated station, 3857 * AP, IBSS/WDS/mesh peer etc. This callback can sleep. 3858 * 3859 * @sta_remove: Notifies low level driver about removal of an associated 3860 * station, AP, IBSS/WDS/mesh peer etc. Note that after the callback 3861 * returns it isn't safe to use the pointer, not even RCU protected; 3862 * no RCU grace period is guaranteed between returning here and freeing 3863 * the station. See @sta_pre_rcu_remove if needed. 3864 * This callback can sleep. 3865 * 3866 * @link_add_debugfs: Drivers can use this callback to add debugfs files 3867 * when a link is added to a mac80211 vif. This callback should be within 3868 * a CONFIG_MAC80211_DEBUGFS conditional. This callback can sleep. 3869 * For non-MLO the callback will be called once for the default bss_conf 3870 * with the vif's directory rather than a separate subdirectory. 3871 * 3872 * @sta_add_debugfs: Drivers can use this callback to add debugfs files 3873 * when a station is added to mac80211's station list. This callback 3874 * should be within a CONFIG_MAC80211_DEBUGFS conditional. This 3875 * callback can sleep. 3876 * 3877 * @link_sta_add_debugfs: Drivers can use this callback to add debugfs files 3878 * when a link is added to a mac80211 station. This callback 3879 * should be within a CONFIG_MAC80211_DEBUGFS conditional. This 3880 * callback can sleep. 3881 * For non-MLO the callback will be called once for the deflink with the 3882 * station's directory rather than a separate subdirectory. 3883 * 3884 * @sta_notify: Notifies low level driver about power state transition of an 3885 * associated station, AP, IBSS/WDS/mesh peer etc. For a VIF operating 3886 * in AP mode, this callback will not be called when the flag 3887 * %IEEE80211_HW_AP_LINK_PS is set. Must be atomic. 3888 * 3889 * @sta_set_txpwr: Configure the station tx power. This callback set the tx 3890 * power for the station. 3891 * This callback can sleep. 3892 * 3893 * @sta_state: Notifies low level driver about state transition of a 3894 * station (which can be the AP, a client, IBSS/WDS/mesh peer etc.) 3895 * This callback is mutually exclusive with @sta_add/@sta_remove. 3896 * It must not fail for down transitions but may fail for transitions 3897 * up the list of states. Also note that after the callback returns it 3898 * isn't safe to use the pointer, not even RCU protected - no RCU grace 3899 * period is guaranteed between returning here and freeing the station. 3900 * See @sta_pre_rcu_remove if needed. 3901 * The callback can sleep. 3902 * 3903 * @sta_pre_rcu_remove: Notify driver about station removal before RCU 3904 * synchronisation. This is useful if a driver needs to have station 3905 * pointers protected using RCU, it can then use this call to clear 3906 * the pointers instead of waiting for an RCU grace period to elapse 3907 * in @sta_state. 3908 * The callback can sleep. 3909 * 3910 * @sta_rc_update: Notifies the driver of changes to the bitrates that can be 3911 * used to transmit to the station. The changes are advertised with bits 3912 * from &enum ieee80211_rate_control_changed and the values are reflected 3913 * in the station data. This callback should only be used when the driver 3914 * uses hardware rate control (%IEEE80211_HW_HAS_RATE_CONTROL) since 3915 * otherwise the rate control algorithm is notified directly. 3916 * Must be atomic. 3917 * @sta_rate_tbl_update: Notifies the driver that the rate table changed. This 3918 * is only used if the configured rate control algorithm actually uses 3919 * the new rate table API, and is therefore optional. Must be atomic. 3920 * 3921 * @sta_statistics: Get statistics for this station. For example with beacon 3922 * filtering, the statistics kept by mac80211 might not be accurate, so 3923 * let the driver pre-fill the statistics. The driver can fill most of 3924 * the values (indicating which by setting the filled bitmap), but not 3925 * all of them make sense - see the source for which ones are possible. 3926 * Statistics that the driver doesn't fill will be filled by mac80211. 3927 * The callback can sleep. 3928 * 3929 * @conf_tx: Configure TX queue parameters (EDCF (aifs, cw_min, cw_max), 3930 * bursting) for a hardware TX queue. 3931 * Returns a negative error code on failure. 3932 * The callback can sleep. 3933 * 3934 * @get_tsf: Get the current TSF timer value from firmware/hardware. Currently, 3935 * this is only used for IBSS mode BSSID merging and debugging. Is not a 3936 * required function. 3937 * The callback can sleep. 3938 * 3939 * @set_tsf: Set the TSF timer to the specified value in the firmware/hardware. 3940 * Currently, this is only used for IBSS mode debugging. Is not a 3941 * required function. 3942 * The callback can sleep. 3943 * 3944 * @offset_tsf: Offset the TSF timer by the specified value in the 3945 * firmware/hardware. Preferred to set_tsf as it avoids delay between 3946 * calling set_tsf() and hardware getting programmed, which will show up 3947 * as TSF delay. Is not a required function. 3948 * The callback can sleep. 3949 * 3950 * @reset_tsf: Reset the TSF timer and allow firmware/hardware to synchronize 3951 * with other STAs in the IBSS. This is only used in IBSS mode. This 3952 * function is optional if the firmware/hardware takes full care of 3953 * TSF synchronization. 3954 * The callback can sleep. 3955 * 3956 * @tx_last_beacon: Determine whether the last IBSS beacon was sent by us. 3957 * This is needed only for IBSS mode and the result of this function is 3958 * used to determine whether to reply to Probe Requests. 3959 * Returns non-zero if this device sent the last beacon. 3960 * The callback can sleep. 3961 * 3962 * @get_survey: Return per-channel survey information 3963 * 3964 * @rfkill_poll: Poll rfkill hardware state. If you need this, you also 3965 * need to set wiphy->rfkill_poll to %true before registration, 3966 * and need to call wiphy_rfkill_set_hw_state() in the callback. 3967 * The callback can sleep. 3968 * 3969 * @set_coverage_class: Set slot time for given coverage class as specified 3970 * in IEEE 802.11-2007 section 17.3.8.6 and modify ACK timeout 3971 * accordingly; coverage class equals to -1 to enable ACK timeout 3972 * estimation algorithm (dynack). To disable dynack set valid value for 3973 * coverage class. This callback is not required and may sleep. 3974 * 3975 * @testmode_cmd: Implement a cfg80211 test mode command. The passed @vif may 3976 * be %NULL. The callback can sleep. 3977 * @testmode_dump: Implement a cfg80211 test mode dump. The callback can sleep. 3978 * 3979 * @flush: Flush all pending frames from the hardware queue, making sure 3980 * that the hardware queues are empty. The @queues parameter is a bitmap 3981 * of queues to flush, which is useful if different virtual interfaces 3982 * use different hardware queues; it may also indicate all queues. 3983 * If the parameter @drop is set to %true, pending frames may be dropped. 3984 * Note that vif can be NULL. 3985 * The callback can sleep. 3986 * 3987 * @flush_sta: Flush or drop all pending frames from the hardware queue(s) for 3988 * the given station, as it's about to be removed. 3989 * The callback can sleep. 3990 * 3991 * @channel_switch: Drivers that need (or want) to offload the channel 3992 * switch operation for CSAs received from the AP may implement this 3993 * callback. They must then call ieee80211_chswitch_done() to indicate 3994 * completion of the channel switch. 3995 * 3996 * @set_antenna: Set antenna configuration (tx_ant, rx_ant) on the device. 3997 * Parameters are bitmaps of allowed antennas to use for TX/RX. Drivers may 3998 * reject TX/RX mask combinations they cannot support by returning -EINVAL 3999 * (also see nl80211.h @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_ANTENNA_TX). 4000 * 4001 * @get_antenna: Get current antenna configuration from device (tx_ant, rx_ant). 4002 * 4003 * @remain_on_channel: Starts an off-channel period on the given channel, must 4004 * call back to ieee80211_ready_on_channel() when on that channel. Note 4005 * that normal channel traffic is not stopped as this is intended for hw 4006 * offload. Frames to transmit on the off-channel channel are transmitted 4007 * normally except for the %IEEE80211_TX_CTL_TX_OFFCHAN flag. When the 4008 * duration (which will always be non-zero) expires, the driver must call 4009 * ieee80211_remain_on_channel_expired(). 4010 * Note that this callback may be called while the device is in IDLE and 4011 * must be accepted in this case. 4012 * This callback may sleep. 4013 * @cancel_remain_on_channel: Requests that an ongoing off-channel period is 4014 * aborted before it expires. This callback may sleep. 4015 * 4016 * @set_ringparam: Set tx and rx ring sizes. 4017 * 4018 * @get_ringparam: Get tx and rx ring current and maximum sizes. 4019 * 4020 * @tx_frames_pending: Check if there is any pending frame in the hardware 4021 * queues before entering power save. 4022 * 4023 * @set_bitrate_mask: Set a mask of rates to be used for rate control selection 4024 * when transmitting a frame. Currently only legacy rates are handled. 4025 * The callback can sleep. 4026 * @event_callback: Notify driver about any event in mac80211. See 4027 * &enum ieee80211_event_type for the different types. 4028 * The callback must be atomic. 4029 * 4030 * @release_buffered_frames: Release buffered frames according to the given 4031 * parameters. In the case where the driver buffers some frames for 4032 * sleeping stations mac80211 will use this callback to tell the driver 4033 * to release some frames, either for PS-poll or uAPSD. 4034 * Note that if the @more_data parameter is %false the driver must check 4035 * if there are more frames on the given TIDs, and if there are more than 4036 * the frames being released then it must still set the more-data bit in 4037 * the frame. If the @more_data parameter is %true, then of course the 4038 * more-data bit must always be set. 4039 * The @tids parameter tells the driver which TIDs to release frames 4040 * from, for PS-poll it will always have only a single bit set. 4041 * In the case this is used for a PS-poll initiated release, the 4042 * @num_frames parameter will always be 1 so code can be shared. In 4043 * this case the driver must also set %IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP flag 4044 * on the TX status (and must report TX status) so that the PS-poll 4045 * period is properly ended. This is used to avoid sending multiple 4046 * responses for a retried PS-poll frame. 4047 * In the case this is used for uAPSD, the @num_frames parameter may be 4048 * bigger than one, but the driver may send fewer frames (it must send 4049 * at least one, however). In this case it is also responsible for 4050 * setting the EOSP flag in the QoS header of the frames. Also, when the 4051 * service period ends, the driver must set %IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP 4052 * on the last frame in the SP. Alternatively, it may call the function 4053 * ieee80211_sta_eosp() to inform mac80211 of the end of the SP. 4054 * This callback must be atomic. 4055 * @allow_buffered_frames: Prepare device to allow the given number of frames 4056 * to go out to the given station. The frames will be sent by mac80211 4057 * via the usual TX path after this call. The TX information for frames 4058 * released will also have the %IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_PS_BUFFER flag set 4059 * and the last one will also have %IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP set. In case 4060 * frames from multiple TIDs are released and the driver might reorder 4061 * them between the TIDs, it must set the %IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP flag 4062 * on the last frame and clear it on all others and also handle the EOSP 4063 * bit in the QoS header correctly. Alternatively, it can also call the 4064 * ieee80211_sta_eosp() function. 4065 * The @tids parameter is a bitmap and tells the driver which TIDs the 4066 * frames will be on; it will at most have two bits set. 4067 * This callback must be atomic. 4068 * 4069 * @get_et_sset_count: Ethtool API to get string-set count. 4070 * 4071 * @get_et_stats: Ethtool API to get a set of u64 stats. 4072 * 4073 * @get_et_strings: Ethtool API to get a set of strings to describe stats 4074 * and perhaps other supported types of ethtool data-sets. 4075 * 4076 * @mgd_prepare_tx: Prepare for transmitting a management frame for association 4077 * before associated. In multi-channel scenarios, a virtual interface is 4078 * bound to a channel before it is associated, but as it isn't associated 4079 * yet it need not necessarily be given airtime, in particular since any 4080 * transmission to a P2P GO needs to be synchronized against the GO's 4081 * powersave state. mac80211 will call this function before transmitting a 4082 * management frame prior to having successfully associated to allow the 4083 * driver to give it channel time for the transmission, to get a response 4084 * and to be able to synchronize with the GO. 4085 * For drivers that set %IEEE80211_HW_DEAUTH_NEED_MGD_TX_PREP, mac80211 4086 * would also call this function before transmitting a deauthentication 4087 * frame in case that no beacon was heard from the AP/P2P GO. 4088 * The callback will be called before each transmission and upon return 4089 * mac80211 will transmit the frame right away. 4090 * Additional information is passed in the &struct ieee80211_prep_tx_info 4091 * data. If duration there is greater than zero, mac80211 hints to the 4092 * driver the duration for which the operation is requested. 4093 * The callback is optional and can (should!) sleep. 4094 * @mgd_complete_tx: Notify the driver that the response frame for a previously 4095 * transmitted frame announced with @mgd_prepare_tx was received, the data 4096 * is filled similarly to @mgd_prepare_tx though the duration is not used. 4097 * 4098 * @mgd_protect_tdls_discover: Protect a TDLS discovery session. After sending 4099 * a TDLS discovery-request, we expect a reply to arrive on the AP's 4100 * channel. We must stay on the channel (no PSM, scan, etc.), since a TDLS 4101 * setup-response is a direct packet not buffered by the AP. 4102 * mac80211 will call this function just before the transmission of a TDLS 4103 * discovery-request. The recommended period of protection is at least 4104 * 2 * (DTIM period). 4105 * The callback is optional and can sleep. 4106 * 4107 * @add_chanctx: Notifies device driver about new channel context creation. 4108 * This callback may sleep. 4109 * @remove_chanctx: Notifies device driver about channel context destruction. 4110 * This callback may sleep. 4111 * @change_chanctx: Notifies device driver about channel context changes that 4112 * may happen when combining different virtual interfaces on the same 4113 * channel context with different settings 4114 * This callback may sleep. 4115 * @assign_vif_chanctx: Notifies device driver about channel context being bound 4116 * to vif. Possible use is for hw queue remapping. 4117 * This callback may sleep. 4118 * @unassign_vif_chanctx: Notifies device driver about channel context being 4119 * unbound from vif. 4120 * This callback may sleep. 4121 * @switch_vif_chanctx: switch a number of vifs from one chanctx to 4122 * another, as specified in the list of 4123 * @ieee80211_vif_chanctx_switch passed to the driver, according 4124 * to the mode defined in &ieee80211_chanctx_switch_mode. 4125 * This callback may sleep. 4126 * 4127 * @start_ap: Start operation on the AP interface, this is called after all the 4128 * information in bss_conf is set and beacon can be retrieved. A channel 4129 * context is bound before this is called. Note that if the driver uses 4130 * software scan or ROC, this (and @stop_ap) isn't called when the AP is 4131 * just "paused" for scanning/ROC, which is indicated by the beacon being 4132 * disabled/enabled via @bss_info_changed. 4133 * @stop_ap: Stop operation on the AP interface. 4134 * 4135 * @reconfig_complete: Called after a call to ieee80211_restart_hw() and 4136 * during resume, when the reconfiguration has completed. 4137 * This can help the driver implement the reconfiguration step (and 4138 * indicate mac80211 is ready to receive frames). 4139 * This callback may sleep. 4140 * 4141 * @ipv6_addr_change: IPv6 address assignment on the given interface changed. 4142 * Currently, this is only called for managed or P2P client interfaces. 4143 * This callback is optional; it must not sleep. 4144 * 4145 * @channel_switch_beacon: Starts a channel switch to a new channel. 4146 * Beacons are modified to include CSA or ECSA IEs before calling this 4147 * function. The corresponding count fields in these IEs must be 4148 * decremented, and when they reach 1 the driver must call 4149 * ieee80211_csa_finish(). Drivers which use ieee80211_beacon_get() 4150 * get the csa counter decremented by mac80211, but must check if it is 4151 * 1 using ieee80211_beacon_counter_is_complete() after the beacon has been 4152 * transmitted and then call ieee80211_csa_finish(). 4153 * If the CSA count starts as zero or 1, this function will not be called, 4154 * since there won't be any time to beacon before the switch anyway. 4155 * @pre_channel_switch: This is an optional callback that is called 4156 * before a channel switch procedure is started (ie. when a STA 4157 * gets a CSA or a userspace initiated channel-switch), allowing 4158 * the driver to prepare for the channel switch. 4159 * @post_channel_switch: This is an optional callback that is called 4160 * after a channel switch procedure is completed, allowing the 4161 * driver to go back to a normal configuration. 4162 * @abort_channel_switch: This is an optional callback that is called 4163 * when channel switch procedure was completed, allowing the 4164 * driver to go back to a normal configuration. 4165 * @channel_switch_rx_beacon: This is an optional callback that is called 4166 * when channel switch procedure is in progress and additional beacon with 4167 * CSA IE was received, allowing driver to track changes in count. 4168 * @join_ibss: Join an IBSS (on an IBSS interface); this is called after all 4169 * information in bss_conf is set up and the beacon can be retrieved. A 4170 * channel context is bound before this is called. 4171 * @leave_ibss: Leave the IBSS again. 4172 * 4173 * @get_expected_throughput: extract the expected throughput towards the 4174 * specified station. The returned value is expressed in Kbps. It returns 0 4175 * if the RC algorithm does not have proper data to provide. 4176 * 4177 * @get_txpower: get current maximum tx power (in dBm) based on configuration 4178 * and hardware limits. 4179 * 4180 * @tdls_channel_switch: Start channel-switching with a TDLS peer. The driver 4181 * is responsible for continually initiating channel-switching operations 4182 * and returning to the base channel for communication with the AP. The 4183 * driver receives a channel-switch request template and the location of 4184 * the switch-timing IE within the template as part of the invocation. 4185 * The template is valid only within the call, and the driver can 4186 * optionally copy the skb for further re-use. 4187 * @tdls_cancel_channel_switch: Stop channel-switching with a TDLS peer. Both 4188 * peers must be on the base channel when the call completes. 4189 * @tdls_recv_channel_switch: a TDLS channel-switch related frame (request or 4190 * response) has been received from a remote peer. The driver gets 4191 * parameters parsed from the incoming frame and may use them to continue 4192 * an ongoing channel-switch operation. In addition, a channel-switch 4193 * response template is provided, together with the location of the 4194 * switch-timing IE within the template. The skb can only be used within 4195 * the function call. 4196 * 4197 * @wake_tx_queue: Called when new packets have been added to the queue. 4198 * @sync_rx_queues: Process all pending frames in RSS queues. This is a 4199 * synchronization which is needed in case driver has in its RSS queues 4200 * pending frames that were received prior to the control path action 4201 * currently taken (e.g. disassociation) but are not processed yet. 4202 * 4203 * @start_nan: join an existing NAN cluster, or create a new one. 4204 * @stop_nan: leave the NAN cluster. 4205 * @nan_change_conf: change NAN configuration. The data in cfg80211_nan_conf 4206 * contains full new configuration and changes specify which parameters 4207 * are changed with respect to the last NAN config. 4208 * The driver gets both full configuration and the changed parameters since 4209 * some devices may need the full configuration while others need only the 4210 * changed parameters. 4211 * @add_nan_func: Add a NAN function. Returns 0 on success. The data in 4212 * cfg80211_nan_func must not be referenced outside the scope of 4213 * this call. 4214 * @del_nan_func: Remove a NAN function. The driver must call 4215 * ieee80211_nan_func_terminated() with 4216 * NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TERM_REASON_USER_REQUEST reason code upon removal. 4217 * @can_aggregate_in_amsdu: Called in order to determine if HW supports 4218 * aggregating two specific frames in the same A-MSDU. The relation 4219 * between the skbs should be symmetric and transitive. Note that while 4220 * skb is always a real frame, head may or may not be an A-MSDU. 4221 * @get_ftm_responder_stats: Retrieve FTM responder statistics, if available. 4222 * Statistics should be cumulative, currently no way to reset is provided. 4223 * 4224 * @start_pmsr: start peer measurement (e.g. FTM) (this call can sleep) 4225 * @abort_pmsr: abort peer measurement (this call can sleep) 4226 * @set_tid_config: Apply TID specific configurations. This callback may sleep. 4227 * @reset_tid_config: Reset TID specific configuration for the peer. 4228 * This callback may sleep. 4229 * @update_vif_offload: Update virtual interface offload flags 4230 * This callback may sleep. 4231 * @sta_set_4addr: Called to notify the driver when a station starts/stops using 4232 * 4-address mode 4233 * @set_sar_specs: Update the SAR (TX power) settings. 4234 * @sta_set_decap_offload: Called to notify the driver when a station is allowed 4235 * to use rx decapsulation offload 4236 * @add_twt_setup: Update hw with TWT agreement parameters received from the peer. 4237 * This callback allows the hw to check if requested parameters 4238 * are supported and if there is enough room for a new agreement. 4239 * The hw is expected to set agreement result in the req_type field of 4240 * twt structure. 4241 * @twt_teardown_request: Update the hw with TWT teardown request received 4242 * from the peer. 4243 * @set_radar_background: Configure dedicated offchannel chain available for 4244 * radar/CAC detection on some hw. This chain can't be used to transmit 4245 * or receive frames and it is bounded to a running wdev. 4246 * Background radar/CAC detection allows to avoid the CAC downtime 4247 * switching to a different channel during CAC detection on the selected 4248 * radar channel. 4249 * The caller is expected to set chandef pointer to NULL in order to 4250 * disable background CAC/radar detection. 4251 * @net_fill_forward_path: Called from .ndo_fill_forward_path in order to 4252 * resolve a path for hardware flow offloading 4253 * @change_vif_links: Change the valid links on an interface, note that while 4254 * removing the old link information is still valid (link_conf pointer), 4255 * but may immediately disappear after the function returns. The old or 4256 * new links bitmaps may be 0 if going from/to a non-MLO situation. 4257 * The @old array contains pointers to the old bss_conf structures 4258 * that were already removed, in case they're needed. 4259 * This callback can sleep. 4260 * @change_sta_links: Change the valid links of a station, similar to 4261 * @change_vif_links. This callback can sleep. 4262 * Note that a sta can also be inserted or removed with valid links, 4263 * i.e. passed to @sta_add/@sta_state with sta->valid_links not zero. 4264 * In fact, cannot change from having valid_links and not having them. 4265 * @set_hw_timestamp: Enable/disable HW timestamping of TM/FTM frames. This is 4266 * not restored at HW reset by mac80211 so drivers need to take care of 4267 * that. 4268 * @net_setup_tc: Called from .ndo_setup_tc in order to prepare hardware 4269 * flow offloading for flows originating from the vif. 4270 * Note that the driver must not assume that the vif driver_data is valid 4271 * at this point, since the callback can be called during netdev teardown. 4272 */ 4273 struct ieee80211_ops { 4274 void (*tx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4275 struct ieee80211_tx_control *control, 4276 struct sk_buff *skb); 4277 int (*start)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw); 4278 void (*stop)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw); 4279 #ifdef CONFIG_PM 4280 int (*suspend)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct cfg80211_wowlan *wowlan); 4281 int (*resume)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw); 4282 void (*set_wakeup)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, bool enabled); 4283 #endif 4284 int (*add_interface)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4285 struct ieee80211_vif *vif); 4286 int (*change_interface)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4287 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4288 enum nl80211_iftype new_type, bool p2p); 4289 void (*remove_interface)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4290 struct ieee80211_vif *vif); 4291 int (*config)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u32 changed); 4292 void (*bss_info_changed)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4293 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4294 struct ieee80211_bss_conf *info, 4295 u64 changed); 4296 void (*vif_cfg_changed)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4297 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4298 u64 changed); 4299 void (*link_info_changed)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4300 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4301 struct ieee80211_bss_conf *info, 4302 u64 changed); 4303 4304 int (*start_ap)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4305 struct ieee80211_bss_conf *link_conf); 4306 void (*stop_ap)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4307 struct ieee80211_bss_conf *link_conf); 4308 4309 u64 (*prepare_multicast)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4310 struct netdev_hw_addr_list *mc_list); 4311 void (*configure_filter)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4312 unsigned int changed_flags, 4313 unsigned int *total_flags, 4314 u64 multicast); 4315 void (*config_iface_filter)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4316 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4317 unsigned int filter_flags, 4318 unsigned int changed_flags); 4319 int (*set_tim)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_sta *sta, 4320 bool set); 4321 int (*set_key)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, enum set_key_cmd cmd, 4322 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, struct ieee80211_sta *sta, 4323 struct ieee80211_key_conf *key); 4324 void (*update_tkip_key)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4325 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4326 struct ieee80211_key_conf *conf, 4327 struct ieee80211_sta *sta, 4328 u32 iv32, u16 *phase1key); 4329 void (*set_rekey_data)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4330 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4331 struct cfg80211_gtk_rekey_data *data); 4332 void (*set_default_unicast_key)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4333 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, int idx); 4334 int (*hw_scan)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4335 struct ieee80211_scan_request *req); 4336 void (*cancel_hw_scan)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4337 struct ieee80211_vif *vif); 4338 int (*sched_scan_start)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4339 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4340 struct cfg80211_sched_scan_request *req, 4341 struct ieee80211_scan_ies *ies); 4342 int (*sched_scan_stop)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4343 struct ieee80211_vif *vif); 4344 void (*sw_scan_start)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4345 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4346 const u8 *mac_addr); 4347 void (*sw_scan_complete)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4348 struct ieee80211_vif *vif); 4349 int (*get_stats)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4350 struct ieee80211_low_level_stats *stats); 4351 void (*get_key_seq)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4352 struct ieee80211_key_conf *key, 4353 struct ieee80211_key_seq *seq); 4354 int (*set_frag_threshold)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u32 value); 4355 int (*set_rts_threshold)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u32 value); 4356 int (*sta_add)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4357 struct ieee80211_sta *sta); 4358 int (*sta_remove)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4359 struct ieee80211_sta *sta); 4360 #ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_DEBUGFS 4361 void (*link_add_debugfs)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4362 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4363 struct ieee80211_bss_conf *link_conf, 4364 struct dentry *dir); 4365 void (*sta_add_debugfs)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4366 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4367 struct ieee80211_sta *sta, 4368 struct dentry *dir); 4369 void (*link_sta_add_debugfs)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4370 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4371 struct ieee80211_link_sta *link_sta, 4372 struct dentry *dir); 4373 #endif 4374 void (*sta_notify)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4375 enum sta_notify_cmd, struct ieee80211_sta *sta); 4376 int (*sta_set_txpwr)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4377 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4378 struct ieee80211_sta *sta); 4379 int (*sta_state)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4380 struct ieee80211_sta *sta, 4381 enum ieee80211_sta_state old_state, 4382 enum ieee80211_sta_state new_state); 4383 void (*sta_pre_rcu_remove)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4384 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4385 struct ieee80211_sta *sta); 4386 void (*sta_rc_update)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4387 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4388 struct ieee80211_sta *sta, 4389 u32 changed); 4390 void (*sta_rate_tbl_update)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4391 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4392 struct ieee80211_sta *sta); 4393 void (*sta_statistics)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4394 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4395 struct ieee80211_sta *sta, 4396 struct station_info *sinfo); 4397 int (*conf_tx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4398 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4399 unsigned int link_id, u16 ac, 4400 const struct ieee80211_tx_queue_params *params); 4401 u64 (*get_tsf)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif); 4402 void (*set_tsf)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4403 u64 tsf); 4404 void (*offset_tsf)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4405 s64 offset); 4406 void (*reset_tsf)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif); 4407 int (*tx_last_beacon)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw); 4408 4409 /** 4410 * @ampdu_action: 4411 * Perform a certain A-MPDU action. 4412 * The RA/TID combination determines the destination and TID we want 4413 * the ampdu action to be performed for. The action is defined through 4414 * ieee80211_ampdu_mlme_action. 4415 * When the action is set to %IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_OPERATIONAL the driver 4416 * may neither send aggregates containing more subframes than @buf_size 4417 * nor send aggregates in a way that lost frames would exceed the 4418 * buffer size. If just limiting the aggregate size, this would be 4419 * possible with a buf_size of 8: 4420 * 4421 * - ``TX: 1.....7`` 4422 * - ``RX: 2....7`` (lost frame #1) 4423 * - ``TX: 8..1...`` 4424 * 4425 * which is invalid since #1 was now re-transmitted well past the 4426 * buffer size of 8. Correct ways to retransmit #1 would be: 4427 * 4428 * - ``TX: 1 or`` 4429 * - ``TX: 18 or`` 4430 * - ``TX: 81`` 4431 * 4432 * Even ``189`` would be wrong since 1 could be lost again. 4433 * 4434 * Returns a negative error code on failure. The driver may return 4435 * %IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_START_IMMEDIATE for %IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_START 4436 * if the session can start immediately. 4437 * 4438 * The callback can sleep. 4439 */ 4440 int (*ampdu_action)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4441 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4442 struct ieee80211_ampdu_params *params); 4443 int (*get_survey)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, int idx, 4444 struct survey_info *survey); 4445 void (*rfkill_poll)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw); 4446 void (*set_coverage_class)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, s16 coverage_class); 4447 #ifdef CONFIG_NL80211_TESTMODE 4448 int (*testmode_cmd)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4449 void *data, int len); 4450 int (*testmode_dump)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct sk_buff *skb, 4451 struct netlink_callback *cb, 4452 void *data, int len); 4453 #endif 4454 void (*flush)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4455 u32 queues, bool drop); 4456 void (*flush_sta)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4457 struct ieee80211_sta *sta); 4458 void (*channel_switch)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4459 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4460 struct ieee80211_channel_switch *ch_switch); 4461 int (*set_antenna)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u32 tx_ant, u32 rx_ant); 4462 int (*get_antenna)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u32 *tx_ant, u32 *rx_ant); 4463 4464 int (*remain_on_channel)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4465 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4466 struct ieee80211_channel *chan, 4467 int duration, 4468 enum ieee80211_roc_type type); 4469 int (*cancel_remain_on_channel)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4470 struct ieee80211_vif *vif); 4471 int (*set_ringparam)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u32 tx, u32 rx); 4472 void (*get_ringparam)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4473 u32 *tx, u32 *tx_max, u32 *rx, u32 *rx_max); 4474 bool (*tx_frames_pending)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw); 4475 int (*set_bitrate_mask)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4476 const struct cfg80211_bitrate_mask *mask); 4477 void (*event_callback)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4478 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4479 const struct ieee80211_event *event); 4480 4481 void (*allow_buffered_frames)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4482 struct ieee80211_sta *sta, 4483 u16 tids, int num_frames, 4484 enum ieee80211_frame_release_type reason, 4485 bool more_data); 4486 void (*release_buffered_frames)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4487 struct ieee80211_sta *sta, 4488 u16 tids, int num_frames, 4489 enum ieee80211_frame_release_type reason, 4490 bool more_data); 4491 4492 int (*get_et_sset_count)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4493 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, int sset); 4494 void (*get_et_stats)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4495 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4496 struct ethtool_stats *stats, u64 *data); 4497 void (*get_et_strings)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4498 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4499 u32 sset, u8 *data); 4500 4501 void (*mgd_prepare_tx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4502 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4503 struct ieee80211_prep_tx_info *info); 4504 void (*mgd_complete_tx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4505 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4506 struct ieee80211_prep_tx_info *info); 4507 4508 void (*mgd_protect_tdls_discover)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4509 struct ieee80211_vif *vif); 4510 4511 int (*add_chanctx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4512 struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *ctx); 4513 void (*remove_chanctx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4514 struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *ctx); 4515 void (*change_chanctx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4516 struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *ctx, 4517 u32 changed); 4518 int (*assign_vif_chanctx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4519 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4520 struct ieee80211_bss_conf *link_conf, 4521 struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *ctx); 4522 void (*unassign_vif_chanctx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4523 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4524 struct ieee80211_bss_conf *link_conf, 4525 struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *ctx); 4526 int (*switch_vif_chanctx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4527 struct ieee80211_vif_chanctx_switch *vifs, 4528 int n_vifs, 4529 enum ieee80211_chanctx_switch_mode mode); 4530 4531 void (*reconfig_complete)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4532 enum ieee80211_reconfig_type reconfig_type); 4533 4534 #if IS_ENABLED(CONFIG_IPV6) 4535 void (*ipv6_addr_change)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4536 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4537 struct inet6_dev *idev); 4538 #endif 4539 void (*channel_switch_beacon)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4540 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4541 struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef); 4542 int (*pre_channel_switch)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4543 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4544 struct ieee80211_channel_switch *ch_switch); 4545 4546 int (*post_channel_switch)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4547 struct ieee80211_vif *vif); 4548 void (*abort_channel_switch)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4549 struct ieee80211_vif *vif); 4550 void (*channel_switch_rx_beacon)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4551 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4552 struct ieee80211_channel_switch *ch_switch); 4553 4554 int (*join_ibss)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif); 4555 void (*leave_ibss)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif); 4556 u32 (*get_expected_throughput)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4557 struct ieee80211_sta *sta); 4558 int (*get_txpower)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4559 int *dbm); 4560 4561 int (*tdls_channel_switch)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4562 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4563 struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u8 oper_class, 4564 struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef, 4565 struct sk_buff *tmpl_skb, u32 ch_sw_tm_ie); 4566 void (*tdls_cancel_channel_switch)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4567 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4568 struct ieee80211_sta *sta); 4569 void (*tdls_recv_channel_switch)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4570 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4571 struct ieee80211_tdls_ch_sw_params *params); 4572 4573 void (*wake_tx_queue)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4574 struct ieee80211_txq *txq); 4575 void (*sync_rx_queues)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw); 4576 4577 int (*start_nan)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4578 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4579 struct cfg80211_nan_conf *conf); 4580 int (*stop_nan)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4581 struct ieee80211_vif *vif); 4582 int (*nan_change_conf)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4583 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4584 struct cfg80211_nan_conf *conf, u32 changes); 4585 int (*add_nan_func)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4586 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4587 const struct cfg80211_nan_func *nan_func); 4588 void (*del_nan_func)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4589 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4590 u8 instance_id); 4591 bool (*can_aggregate_in_amsdu)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4592 struct sk_buff *head, 4593 struct sk_buff *skb); 4594 int (*get_ftm_responder_stats)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4595 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4596 struct cfg80211_ftm_responder_stats *ftm_stats); 4597 int (*start_pmsr)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4598 struct cfg80211_pmsr_request *request); 4599 void (*abort_pmsr)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4600 struct cfg80211_pmsr_request *request); 4601 int (*set_tid_config)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4602 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4603 struct ieee80211_sta *sta, 4604 struct cfg80211_tid_config *tid_conf); 4605 int (*reset_tid_config)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4606 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4607 struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u8 tids); 4608 void (*update_vif_offload)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4609 struct ieee80211_vif *vif); 4610 void (*sta_set_4addr)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4611 struct ieee80211_sta *sta, bool enabled); 4612 int (*set_sar_specs)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4613 const struct cfg80211_sar_specs *sar); 4614 void (*sta_set_decap_offload)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4615 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4616 struct ieee80211_sta *sta, bool enabled); 4617 void (*add_twt_setup)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4618 struct ieee80211_sta *sta, 4619 struct ieee80211_twt_setup *twt); 4620 void (*twt_teardown_request)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4621 struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u8 flowid); 4622 int (*set_radar_background)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4623 struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef); 4624 int (*net_fill_forward_path)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4625 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4626 struct ieee80211_sta *sta, 4627 struct net_device_path_ctx *ctx, 4628 struct net_device_path *path); 4629 int (*change_vif_links)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4630 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4631 u16 old_links, u16 new_links, 4632 struct ieee80211_bss_conf *old[IEEE80211_MLD_MAX_NUM_LINKS]); 4633 int (*change_sta_links)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4634 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4635 struct ieee80211_sta *sta, 4636 u16 old_links, u16 new_links); 4637 int (*set_hw_timestamp)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4638 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4639 struct cfg80211_set_hw_timestamp *hwts); 4640 int (*net_setup_tc)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4641 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4642 struct net_device *dev, 4643 enum tc_setup_type type, 4644 void *type_data); 4645 }; 4646 4647 /** 4648 * ieee80211_alloc_hw_nm - Allocate a new hardware device 4649 * 4650 * This must be called once for each hardware device. The returned pointer 4651 * must be used to refer to this device when calling other functions. 4652 * mac80211 allocates a private data area for the driver pointed to by 4653 * @priv in &struct ieee80211_hw, the size of this area is given as 4654 * @priv_data_len. 4655 * 4656 * @priv_data_len: length of private data 4657 * @ops: callbacks for this device 4658 * @requested_name: Requested name for this device. 4659 * NULL is valid value, and means use the default naming (phy%d) 4660 * 4661 * Return: A pointer to the new hardware device, or %NULL on error. 4662 */ 4663 struct ieee80211_hw *ieee80211_alloc_hw_nm(size_t priv_data_len, 4664 const struct ieee80211_ops *ops, 4665 const char *requested_name); 4666 4667 /** 4668 * ieee80211_alloc_hw - Allocate a new hardware device 4669 * 4670 * This must be called once for each hardware device. The returned pointer 4671 * must be used to refer to this device when calling other functions. 4672 * mac80211 allocates a private data area for the driver pointed to by 4673 * @priv in &struct ieee80211_hw, the size of this area is given as 4674 * @priv_data_len. 4675 * 4676 * @priv_data_len: length of private data 4677 * @ops: callbacks for this device 4678 * 4679 * Return: A pointer to the new hardware device, or %NULL on error. 4680 */ 4681 static inline 4682 struct ieee80211_hw *ieee80211_alloc_hw(size_t priv_data_len, 4683 const struct ieee80211_ops *ops) 4684 { 4685 return ieee80211_alloc_hw_nm(priv_data_len, ops, NULL); 4686 } 4687 4688 /** 4689 * ieee80211_register_hw - Register hardware device 4690 * 4691 * You must call this function before any other functions in 4692 * mac80211. Note that before a hardware can be registered, you 4693 * need to fill the contained wiphy's information. 4694 * 4695 * @hw: the device to register as returned by ieee80211_alloc_hw() 4696 * 4697 * Return: 0 on success. An error code otherwise. 4698 */ 4699 int ieee80211_register_hw(struct ieee80211_hw *hw); 4700 4701 /** 4702 * struct ieee80211_tpt_blink - throughput blink description 4703 * @throughput: throughput in Kbit/sec 4704 * @blink_time: blink time in milliseconds 4705 * (full cycle, ie. one off + one on period) 4706 */ 4707 struct ieee80211_tpt_blink { 4708 int throughput; 4709 int blink_time; 4710 }; 4711 4712 /** 4713 * enum ieee80211_tpt_led_trigger_flags - throughput trigger flags 4714 * @IEEE80211_TPT_LEDTRIG_FL_RADIO: enable blinking with radio 4715 * @IEEE80211_TPT_LEDTRIG_FL_WORK: enable blinking when working 4716 * @IEEE80211_TPT_LEDTRIG_FL_CONNECTED: enable blinking when at least one 4717 * interface is connected in some way, including being an AP 4718 */ 4719 enum ieee80211_tpt_led_trigger_flags { 4720 IEEE80211_TPT_LEDTRIG_FL_RADIO = BIT(0), 4721 IEEE80211_TPT_LEDTRIG_FL_WORK = BIT(1), 4722 IEEE80211_TPT_LEDTRIG_FL_CONNECTED = BIT(2), 4723 }; 4724 4725 #ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_LEDS 4726 const char *__ieee80211_get_tx_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw *hw); 4727 const char *__ieee80211_get_rx_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw *hw); 4728 const char *__ieee80211_get_assoc_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw *hw); 4729 const char *__ieee80211_get_radio_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw *hw); 4730 const char * 4731 __ieee80211_create_tpt_led_trigger(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4732 unsigned int flags, 4733 const struct ieee80211_tpt_blink *blink_table, 4734 unsigned int blink_table_len); 4735 #endif 4736 /** 4737 * ieee80211_get_tx_led_name - get name of TX LED 4738 * 4739 * mac80211 creates a transmit LED trigger for each wireless hardware 4740 * that can be used to drive LEDs if your driver registers a LED device. 4741 * This function returns the name (or %NULL if not configured for LEDs) 4742 * of the trigger so you can automatically link the LED device. 4743 * 4744 * @hw: the hardware to get the LED trigger name for 4745 * 4746 * Return: The name of the LED trigger. %NULL if not configured for LEDs. 4747 */ 4748 static inline const char *ieee80211_get_tx_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw *hw) 4749 { 4750 #ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_LEDS 4751 return __ieee80211_get_tx_led_name(hw); 4752 #else 4753 return NULL; 4754 #endif 4755 } 4756 4757 /** 4758 * ieee80211_get_rx_led_name - get name of RX LED 4759 * 4760 * mac80211 creates a receive LED trigger for each wireless hardware 4761 * that can be used to drive LEDs if your driver registers a LED device. 4762 * This function returns the name (or %NULL if not configured for LEDs) 4763 * of the trigger so you can automatically link the LED device. 4764 * 4765 * @hw: the hardware to get the LED trigger name for 4766 * 4767 * Return: The name of the LED trigger. %NULL if not configured for LEDs. 4768 */ 4769 static inline const char *ieee80211_get_rx_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw *hw) 4770 { 4771 #ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_LEDS 4772 return __ieee80211_get_rx_led_name(hw); 4773 #else 4774 return NULL; 4775 #endif 4776 } 4777 4778 /** 4779 * ieee80211_get_assoc_led_name - get name of association LED 4780 * 4781 * mac80211 creates a association LED trigger for each wireless hardware 4782 * that can be used to drive LEDs if your driver registers a LED device. 4783 * This function returns the name (or %NULL if not configured for LEDs) 4784 * of the trigger so you can automatically link the LED device. 4785 * 4786 * @hw: the hardware to get the LED trigger name for 4787 * 4788 * Return: The name of the LED trigger. %NULL if not configured for LEDs. 4789 */ 4790 static inline const char *ieee80211_get_assoc_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw *hw) 4791 { 4792 #ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_LEDS 4793 return __ieee80211_get_assoc_led_name(hw); 4794 #else 4795 return NULL; 4796 #endif 4797 } 4798 4799 /** 4800 * ieee80211_get_radio_led_name - get name of radio LED 4801 * 4802 * mac80211 creates a radio change LED trigger for each wireless hardware 4803 * that can be used to drive LEDs if your driver registers a LED device. 4804 * This function returns the name (or %NULL if not configured for LEDs) 4805 * of the trigger so you can automatically link the LED device. 4806 * 4807 * @hw: the hardware to get the LED trigger name for 4808 * 4809 * Return: The name of the LED trigger. %NULL if not configured for LEDs. 4810 */ 4811 static inline const char *ieee80211_get_radio_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw *hw) 4812 { 4813 #ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_LEDS 4814 return __ieee80211_get_radio_led_name(hw); 4815 #else 4816 return NULL; 4817 #endif 4818 } 4819 4820 /** 4821 * ieee80211_create_tpt_led_trigger - create throughput LED trigger 4822 * @hw: the hardware to create the trigger for 4823 * @flags: trigger flags, see &enum ieee80211_tpt_led_trigger_flags 4824 * @blink_table: the blink table -- needs to be ordered by throughput 4825 * @blink_table_len: size of the blink table 4826 * 4827 * Return: %NULL (in case of error, or if no LED triggers are 4828 * configured) or the name of the new trigger. 4829 * 4830 * Note: This function must be called before ieee80211_register_hw(). 4831 */ 4832 static inline const char * 4833 ieee80211_create_tpt_led_trigger(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, unsigned int flags, 4834 const struct ieee80211_tpt_blink *blink_table, 4835 unsigned int blink_table_len) 4836 { 4837 #ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_LEDS 4838 return __ieee80211_create_tpt_led_trigger(hw, flags, blink_table, 4839 blink_table_len); 4840 #else 4841 return NULL; 4842 #endif 4843 } 4844 4845 /** 4846 * ieee80211_unregister_hw - Unregister a hardware device 4847 * 4848 * This function instructs mac80211 to free allocated resources 4849 * and unregister netdevices from the networking subsystem. 4850 * 4851 * @hw: the hardware to unregister 4852 */ 4853 void ieee80211_unregister_hw(struct ieee80211_hw *hw); 4854 4855 /** 4856 * ieee80211_free_hw - free hardware descriptor 4857 * 4858 * This function frees everything that was allocated, including the 4859 * private data for the driver. You must call ieee80211_unregister_hw() 4860 * before calling this function. 4861 * 4862 * @hw: the hardware to free 4863 */ 4864 void ieee80211_free_hw(struct ieee80211_hw *hw); 4865 4866 /** 4867 * ieee80211_restart_hw - restart hardware completely 4868 * 4869 * Call this function when the hardware was restarted for some reason 4870 * (hardware error, ...) and the driver is unable to restore its state 4871 * by itself. mac80211 assumes that at this point the driver/hardware 4872 * is completely uninitialised and stopped, it starts the process by 4873 * calling the ->start() operation. The driver will need to reset all 4874 * internal state that it has prior to calling this function. 4875 * 4876 * @hw: the hardware to restart 4877 */ 4878 void ieee80211_restart_hw(struct ieee80211_hw *hw); 4879 4880 /** 4881 * ieee80211_rx_list - receive frame and store processed skbs in a list 4882 * 4883 * Use this function to hand received frames to mac80211. The receive 4884 * buffer in @skb must start with an IEEE 802.11 header. In case of a 4885 * paged @skb is used, the driver is recommended to put the ieee80211 4886 * header of the frame on the linear part of the @skb to avoid memory 4887 * allocation and/or memcpy by the stack. 4888 * 4889 * This function may not be called in IRQ context. Calls to this function 4890 * for a single hardware must be synchronized against each other. Calls to 4891 * this function, ieee80211_rx_ni() and ieee80211_rx_irqsafe() may not be 4892 * mixed for a single hardware. Must not run concurrently with 4893 * ieee80211_tx_status() or ieee80211_tx_status_ni(). 4894 * 4895 * This function must be called with BHs disabled and RCU read lock 4896 * 4897 * @hw: the hardware this frame came in on 4898 * @sta: the station the frame was received from, or %NULL 4899 * @skb: the buffer to receive, owned by mac80211 after this call 4900 * @list: the destination list 4901 */ 4902 void ieee80211_rx_list(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_sta *sta, 4903 struct sk_buff *skb, struct list_head *list); 4904 4905 /** 4906 * ieee80211_rx_napi - receive frame from NAPI context 4907 * 4908 * Use this function to hand received frames to mac80211. The receive 4909 * buffer in @skb must start with an IEEE 802.11 header. In case of a 4910 * paged @skb is used, the driver is recommended to put the ieee80211 4911 * header of the frame on the linear part of the @skb to avoid memory 4912 * allocation and/or memcpy by the stack. 4913 * 4914 * This function may not be called in IRQ context. Calls to this function 4915 * for a single hardware must be synchronized against each other. Calls to 4916 * this function, ieee80211_rx_ni() and ieee80211_rx_irqsafe() may not be 4917 * mixed for a single hardware. Must not run concurrently with 4918 * ieee80211_tx_status() or ieee80211_tx_status_ni(). 4919 * 4920 * This function must be called with BHs disabled. 4921 * 4922 * @hw: the hardware this frame came in on 4923 * @sta: the station the frame was received from, or %NULL 4924 * @skb: the buffer to receive, owned by mac80211 after this call 4925 * @napi: the NAPI context 4926 */ 4927 void ieee80211_rx_napi(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_sta *sta, 4928 struct sk_buff *skb, struct napi_struct *napi); 4929 4930 /** 4931 * ieee80211_rx - receive frame 4932 * 4933 * Use this function to hand received frames to mac80211. The receive 4934 * buffer in @skb must start with an IEEE 802.11 header. In case of a 4935 * paged @skb is used, the driver is recommended to put the ieee80211 4936 * header of the frame on the linear part of the @skb to avoid memory 4937 * allocation and/or memcpy by the stack. 4938 * 4939 * This function may not be called in IRQ context. Calls to this function 4940 * for a single hardware must be synchronized against each other. Calls to 4941 * this function, ieee80211_rx_ni() and ieee80211_rx_irqsafe() may not be 4942 * mixed for a single hardware. Must not run concurrently with 4943 * ieee80211_tx_status() or ieee80211_tx_status_ni(). 4944 * 4945 * In process context use instead ieee80211_rx_ni(). 4946 * 4947 * @hw: the hardware this frame came in on 4948 * @skb: the buffer to receive, owned by mac80211 after this call 4949 */ 4950 static inline void ieee80211_rx(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct sk_buff *skb) 4951 { 4952 ieee80211_rx_napi(hw, NULL, skb, NULL); 4953 } 4954 4955 /** 4956 * ieee80211_rx_irqsafe - receive frame 4957 * 4958 * Like ieee80211_rx() but can be called in IRQ context 4959 * (internally defers to a tasklet.) 4960 * 4961 * Calls to this function, ieee80211_rx() or ieee80211_rx_ni() may not 4962 * be mixed for a single hardware.Must not run concurrently with 4963 * ieee80211_tx_status() or ieee80211_tx_status_ni(). 4964 * 4965 * @hw: the hardware this frame came in on 4966 * @skb: the buffer to receive, owned by mac80211 after this call 4967 */ 4968 void ieee80211_rx_irqsafe(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct sk_buff *skb); 4969 4970 /** 4971 * ieee80211_rx_ni - receive frame (in process context) 4972 * 4973 * Like ieee80211_rx() but can be called in process context 4974 * (internally disables bottom halves). 4975 * 4976 * Calls to this function, ieee80211_rx() and ieee80211_rx_irqsafe() may 4977 * not be mixed for a single hardware. Must not run concurrently with 4978 * ieee80211_tx_status() or ieee80211_tx_status_ni(). 4979 * 4980 * @hw: the hardware this frame came in on 4981 * @skb: the buffer to receive, owned by mac80211 after this call 4982 */ 4983 static inline void ieee80211_rx_ni(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4984 struct sk_buff *skb) 4985 { 4986 local_bh_disable(); 4987 ieee80211_rx(hw, skb); 4988 local_bh_enable(); 4989 } 4990 4991 /** 4992 * ieee80211_sta_ps_transition - PS transition for connected sta 4993 * 4994 * When operating in AP mode with the %IEEE80211_HW_AP_LINK_PS 4995 * flag set, use this function to inform mac80211 about a connected station 4996 * entering/leaving PS mode. 4997 * 4998 * This function may not be called in IRQ context or with softirqs enabled. 4999 * 5000 * Calls to this function for a single hardware must be synchronized against 5001 * each other. 5002 * 5003 * @sta: currently connected sta 5004 * @start: start or stop PS 5005 * 5006 * Return: 0 on success. -EINVAL when the requested PS mode is already set. 5007 */ 5008 int ieee80211_sta_ps_transition(struct ieee80211_sta *sta, bool start); 5009 5010 /** 5011 * ieee80211_sta_ps_transition_ni - PS transition for connected sta 5012 * (in process context) 5013 * 5014 * Like ieee80211_sta_ps_transition() but can be called in process context 5015 * (internally disables bottom halves). Concurrent call restriction still 5016 * applies. 5017 * 5018 * @sta: currently connected sta 5019 * @start: start or stop PS 5020 * 5021 * Return: Like ieee80211_sta_ps_transition(). 5022 */ 5023 static inline int ieee80211_sta_ps_transition_ni(struct ieee80211_sta *sta, 5024 bool start) 5025 { 5026 int ret; 5027 5028 local_bh_disable(); 5029 ret = ieee80211_sta_ps_transition(sta, start); 5030 local_bh_enable(); 5031 5032 return ret; 5033 } 5034 5035 /** 5036 * ieee80211_sta_pspoll - PS-Poll frame received 5037 * @sta: currently connected station 5038 * 5039 * When operating in AP mode with the %IEEE80211_HW_AP_LINK_PS flag set, 5040 * use this function to inform mac80211 that a PS-Poll frame from a 5041 * connected station was received. 5042 * This must be used in conjunction with ieee80211_sta_ps_transition() 5043 * and possibly ieee80211_sta_uapsd_trigger(); calls to all three must 5044 * be serialized. 5045 */ 5046 void ieee80211_sta_pspoll(struct ieee80211_sta *sta); 5047 5048 /** 5049 * ieee80211_sta_uapsd_trigger - (potential) U-APSD trigger frame received 5050 * @sta: currently connected station 5051 * @tid: TID of the received (potential) trigger frame 5052 * 5053 * When operating in AP mode with the %IEEE80211_HW_AP_LINK_PS flag set, 5054 * use this function to inform mac80211 that a (potential) trigger frame 5055 * from a connected station was received. 5056 * This must be used in conjunction with ieee80211_sta_ps_transition() 5057 * and possibly ieee80211_sta_pspoll(); calls to all three must be 5058 * serialized. 5059 * %IEEE80211_NUM_TIDS can be passed as the tid if the tid is unknown. 5060 * In this case, mac80211 will not check that this tid maps to an AC 5061 * that is trigger enabled and assume that the caller did the proper 5062 * checks. 5063 */ 5064 void ieee80211_sta_uapsd_trigger(struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u8 tid); 5065 5066 /* 5067 * The TX headroom reserved by mac80211 for its own tx_status functions. 5068 * This is enough for the radiotap header. 5069 */ 5070 #define IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_HEADROOM ALIGN(14, 4) 5071 5072 /** 5073 * ieee80211_sta_set_buffered - inform mac80211 about driver-buffered frames 5074 * @sta: &struct ieee80211_sta pointer for the sleeping station 5075 * @tid: the TID that has buffered frames 5076 * @buffered: indicates whether or not frames are buffered for this TID 5077 * 5078 * If a driver buffers frames for a powersave station instead of passing 5079 * them back to mac80211 for retransmission, the station may still need 5080 * to be told that there are buffered frames via the TIM bit. 5081 * 5082 * This function informs mac80211 whether or not there are frames that are 5083 * buffered in the driver for a given TID; mac80211 can then use this data 5084 * to set the TIM bit (NOTE: This may call back into the driver's set_tim 5085 * call! Beware of the locking!) 5086 * 5087 * If all frames are released to the station (due to PS-poll or uAPSD) 5088 * then the driver needs to inform mac80211 that there no longer are 5089 * frames buffered. However, when the station wakes up mac80211 assumes 5090 * that all buffered frames will be transmitted and clears this data, 5091 * drivers need to make sure they inform mac80211 about all buffered 5092 * frames on the sleep transition (sta_notify() with %STA_NOTIFY_SLEEP). 5093 * 5094 * Note that technically mac80211 only needs to know this per AC, not per 5095 * TID, but since driver buffering will inevitably happen per TID (since 5096 * it is related to aggregation) it is easier to make mac80211 map the 5097 * TID to the AC as required instead of keeping track in all drivers that 5098 * use this API. 5099 */ 5100 void ieee80211_sta_set_buffered(struct ieee80211_sta *sta, 5101 u8 tid, bool buffered); 5102 5103 /** 5104 * ieee80211_get_tx_rates - get the selected transmit rates for a packet 5105 * 5106 * Call this function in a driver with per-packet rate selection support 5107 * to combine the rate info in the packet tx info with the most recent 5108 * rate selection table for the station entry. 5109 * 5110 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback. 5111 * @sta: the receiver station to which this packet is sent. 5112 * @skb: the frame to be transmitted. 5113 * @dest: buffer for extracted rate/retry information 5114 * @max_rates: maximum number of rates to fetch 5115 */ 5116 void ieee80211_get_tx_rates(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 5117 struct ieee80211_sta *sta, 5118 struct sk_buff *skb, 5119 struct ieee80211_tx_rate *dest, 5120 int max_rates); 5121 5122 /** 5123 * ieee80211_sta_set_expected_throughput - set the expected tpt for a station 5124 * 5125 * Call this function to notify mac80211 about a change in expected throughput 5126 * to a station. A driver for a device that does rate control in firmware can 5127 * call this function when the expected throughput estimate towards a station 5128 * changes. The information is used to tune the CoDel AQM applied to traffic 5129 * going towards that station (which can otherwise be too aggressive and cause 5130 * slow stations to starve). 5131 * 5132 * @pubsta: the station to set throughput for. 5133 * @thr: the current expected throughput in kbps. 5134 */ 5135 void ieee80211_sta_set_expected_throughput(struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta, 5136 u32 thr); 5137 5138 /** 5139 * ieee80211_tx_rate_update - transmit rate update callback 5140 * 5141 * Drivers should call this functions with a non-NULL pub sta 5142 * This function can be used in drivers that does not have provision 5143 * in updating the tx rate in data path. 5144 * 5145 * @hw: the hardware the frame was transmitted by 5146 * @pubsta: the station to update the tx rate for. 5147 * @info: tx status information 5148 */ 5149 void ieee80211_tx_rate_update(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 5150 struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta, 5151 struct ieee80211_tx_info *info); 5152 5153 /** 5154 * ieee80211_tx_status - transmit status callback 5155 * 5156 * Call this function for all transmitted frames after they have been 5157 * transmitted. It is permissible to not call this function for 5158 * multicast frames but this can affect statistics. 5159 * 5160 * This function may not be called in IRQ context. Calls to this function 5161 * for a single hardware must be synchronized against each other. Calls 5162 * to this function, ieee80211_tx_status_ni() and ieee80211_tx_status_irqsafe() 5163 * may not be mixed for a single hardware. Must not run concurrently with 5164 * ieee80211_rx() or ieee80211_rx_ni(). 5165 * 5166 * @hw: the hardware the frame was transmitted by 5167 * @skb: the frame that was transmitted, owned by mac80211 after this call 5168 */ 5169 void ieee80211_tx_status(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 5170 struct sk_buff *skb); 5171 5172 /** 5173 * ieee80211_tx_status_ext - extended transmit status callback 5174 * 5175 * This function can be used as a replacement for ieee80211_tx_status 5176 * in drivers that may want to provide extra information that does not 5177 * fit into &struct ieee80211_tx_info. 5178 * 5179 * Calls to this function for a single hardware must be synchronized 5180 * against each other. Calls to this function, ieee80211_tx_status_ni() 5181 * and ieee80211_tx_status_irqsafe() may not be mixed for a single hardware. 5182 * 5183 * @hw: the hardware the frame was transmitted by 5184 * @status: tx status information 5185 */ 5186 void ieee80211_tx_status_ext(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 5187 struct ieee80211_tx_status *status); 5188 5189 /** 5190 * ieee80211_tx_status_noskb - transmit status callback without skb 5191 * 5192 * This function can be used as a replacement for ieee80211_tx_status 5193 * in drivers that cannot reliably map tx status information back to 5194 * specific skbs. 5195 * 5196 * Calls to this function for a single hardware must be synchronized 5197 * against each other. Calls to this function, ieee80211_tx_status_ni() 5198 * and ieee80211_tx_status_irqsafe() may not be mixed for a single hardware. 5199 * 5200 * @hw: the hardware the frame was transmitted by 5201 * @sta: the receiver station to which this packet is sent 5202 * (NULL for multicast packets) 5203 * @info: tx status information 5204 */ 5205 static inline void ieee80211_tx_status_noskb(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 5206 struct ieee80211_sta *sta, 5207 struct ieee80211_tx_info *info) 5208 { 5209 struct ieee80211_tx_status status = { 5210 .sta = sta, 5211 .info = info, 5212 }; 5213 5214 ieee80211_tx_status_ext(hw, &status); 5215 } 5216 5217 /** 5218 * ieee80211_tx_status_ni - transmit status callback (in process context) 5219 * 5220 * Like ieee80211_tx_status() but can be called in process context. 5221 * 5222 * Calls to this function, ieee80211_tx_status() and 5223 * ieee80211_tx_status_irqsafe() may not be mixed 5224 * for a single hardware. 5225 * 5226 * @hw: the hardware the frame was transmitted by 5227 * @skb: the frame that was transmitted, owned by mac80211 after this call 5228 */ 5229 static inline void ieee80211_tx_status_ni(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 5230 struct sk_buff *skb) 5231 { 5232 local_bh_disable(); 5233 ieee80211_tx_status(hw, skb); 5234 local_bh_enable(); 5235 } 5236 5237 /** 5238 * ieee80211_tx_status_irqsafe - IRQ-safe transmit status callback 5239 * 5240 * Like ieee80211_tx_status() but can be called in IRQ context 5241 * (internally defers to a tasklet.) 5242 * 5243 * Calls to this function, ieee80211_tx_status() and 5244 * ieee80211_tx_status_ni() may not be mixed for a single hardware. 5245 * 5246 * @hw: the hardware the frame was transmitted by 5247 * @skb: the frame that was transmitted, owned by mac80211 after this call 5248 */ 5249 void ieee80211_tx_status_irqsafe(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 5250 struct sk_buff *skb); 5251 5252 /** 5253 * ieee80211_report_low_ack - report non-responding station 5254 * 5255 * When operating in AP-mode, call this function to report a non-responding 5256 * connected STA. 5257 * 5258 * @sta: the non-responding connected sta 5259 * @num_packets: number of packets sent to @sta without a response 5260 */ 5261 void ieee80211_report_low_ack(struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u32 num_packets); 5262 5263 #define IEEE80211_MAX_CNTDWN_COUNTERS_NUM 2 5264 5265 /** 5266 * struct ieee80211_mutable_offsets - mutable beacon offsets 5267 * @tim_offset: position of TIM element 5268 * @tim_length: size of TIM element 5269 * @cntdwn_counter_offs: array of IEEE80211_MAX_CNTDWN_COUNTERS_NUM offsets 5270 * to countdown counters. This array can contain zero values which 5271 * should be ignored. 5272 * @mbssid_off: position of the multiple bssid element 5273 */ 5274 struct ieee80211_mutable_offsets { 5275 u16 tim_offset; 5276 u16 tim_length; 5277 5278 u16 cntdwn_counter_offs[IEEE80211_MAX_CNTDWN_COUNTERS_NUM]; 5279 u16 mbssid_off; 5280 }; 5281 5282 /** 5283 * ieee80211_beacon_get_template - beacon template generation function 5284 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw(). 5285 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback. 5286 * @offs: &struct ieee80211_mutable_offsets pointer to struct that will 5287 * receive the offsets that may be updated by the driver. 5288 * @link_id: the link id to which the beacon belongs (or 0 for an AP STA 5289 * that is not associated with AP MLD). 5290 * 5291 * If the driver implements beaconing modes, it must use this function to 5292 * obtain the beacon template. 5293 * 5294 * This function should be used if the beacon frames are generated by the 5295 * device, and then the driver must use the returned beacon as the template 5296 * The driver or the device are responsible to update the DTIM and, when 5297 * applicable, the CSA count. 5298 * 5299 * The driver is responsible for freeing the returned skb. 5300 * 5301 * Return: The beacon template. %NULL on error. 5302 */ 5303 struct sk_buff * 5304 ieee80211_beacon_get_template(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 5305 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 5306 struct ieee80211_mutable_offsets *offs, 5307 unsigned int link_id); 5308 5309 /** 5310 * ieee80211_beacon_get_template_ema_index - EMA beacon template generation 5311 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw(). 5312 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback. 5313 * @offs: &struct ieee80211_mutable_offsets pointer to struct that will 5314 * receive the offsets that may be updated by the driver. 5315 * @link_id: the link id to which the beacon belongs (or 0 for a non-MLD AP). 5316 * @ema_index: index of the beacon in the EMA set. 5317 * 5318 * This function follows the same rules as ieee80211_beacon_get_template() 5319 * but returns a beacon template which includes multiple BSSID element at the 5320 * requested index. 5321 * 5322 * Return: The beacon template. %NULL indicates the end of EMA templates. 5323 */ 5324 struct sk_buff * 5325 ieee80211_beacon_get_template_ema_index(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 5326 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 5327 struct ieee80211_mutable_offsets *offs, 5328 unsigned int link_id, u8 ema_index); 5329 5330 /** 5331 * struct ieee80211_ema_beacons - List of EMA beacons 5332 * @cnt: count of EMA beacons. 5333 * 5334 * @bcn: array of EMA beacons. 5335 * @bcn.skb: the skb containing this specific beacon 5336 * @bcn.offs: &struct ieee80211_mutable_offsets pointer to struct that will 5337 * receive the offsets that may be updated by the driver. 5338 */ 5339 struct ieee80211_ema_beacons { 5340 u8 cnt; 5341 struct { 5342 struct sk_buff *skb; 5343 struct ieee80211_mutable_offsets offs; 5344 } bcn[]; 5345 }; 5346 5347 /** 5348 * ieee80211_beacon_get_template_ema_list - EMA beacon template generation 5349 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw(). 5350 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback. 5351 * @link_id: the link id to which the beacon belongs (or 0 for a non-MLD AP) 5352 * 5353 * This function follows the same rules as ieee80211_beacon_get_template() 5354 * but allocates and returns a pointer to list of all beacon templates required 5355 * to cover all profiles in the multiple BSSID set. Each template includes only 5356 * one multiple BSSID element. 5357 * 5358 * Driver must call ieee80211_beacon_free_ema_list() to free the memory. 5359 * 5360 * Return: EMA beacon templates of type struct ieee80211_ema_beacons *. 5361 * %NULL on error. 5362 */ 5363 struct ieee80211_ema_beacons * 5364 ieee80211_beacon_get_template_ema_list(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 5365 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 5366 unsigned int link_id); 5367 5368 /** 5369 * ieee80211_beacon_free_ema_list - free an EMA beacon template list 5370 * @ema_beacons: list of EMA beacons of type &struct ieee80211_ema_beacons pointers. 5371 * 5372 * This function will free a list previously acquired by calling 5373 * ieee80211_beacon_get_template_ema_list() 5374 */ 5375 void ieee80211_beacon_free_ema_list(struct ieee80211_ema_beacons *ema_beacons); 5376 5377 /** 5378 * ieee80211_beacon_get_tim - beacon generation function 5379 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw(). 5380 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback. 5381 * @tim_offset: pointer to variable that will receive the TIM IE offset. 5382 * Set to 0 if invalid (in non-AP modes). 5383 * @tim_length: pointer to variable that will receive the TIM IE length, 5384 * (including the ID and length bytes!). 5385 * Set to 0 if invalid (in non-AP modes). 5386 * @link_id: the link id to which the beacon belongs (or 0 for an AP STA 5387 * that is not associated with AP MLD). 5388 * 5389 * If the driver implements beaconing modes, it must use this function to 5390 * obtain the beacon frame. 5391 * 5392 * If the beacon frames are generated by the host system (i.e., not in 5393 * hardware/firmware), the driver uses this function to get each beacon 5394 * frame from mac80211 -- it is responsible for calling this function exactly 5395 * once before the beacon is needed (e.g. based on hardware interrupt). 5396 * 5397 * The driver is responsible for freeing the returned skb. 5398 * 5399 * Return: The beacon template. %NULL on error. 5400 */ 5401 struct sk_buff *ieee80211_beacon_get_tim(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 5402 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 5403 u16 *tim_offset, u16 *tim_length, 5404 unsigned int link_id); 5405 5406 /** 5407 * ieee80211_beacon_get - beacon generation function 5408 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw(). 5409 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback. 5410 * @link_id: the link id to which the beacon belongs (or 0 for an AP STA 5411 * that is not associated with AP MLD). 5412 * 5413 * See ieee80211_beacon_get_tim(). 5414 * 5415 * Return: See ieee80211_beacon_get_tim(). 5416 */ 5417 static inline struct sk_buff *ieee80211_beacon_get(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 5418 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 5419 unsigned int link_id) 5420 { 5421 return ieee80211_beacon_get_tim(hw, vif, NULL, NULL, link_id); 5422 } 5423 5424 /** 5425 * ieee80211_beacon_update_cntdwn - request mac80211 to decrement the beacon countdown 5426 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback. 5427 * 5428 * The beacon counter should be updated after each beacon transmission. 5429 * This function is called implicitly when 5430 * ieee80211_beacon_get/ieee80211_beacon_get_tim are called, however if the 5431 * beacon frames are generated by the device, the driver should call this 5432 * function after each beacon transmission to sync mac80211's beacon countdown. 5433 * 5434 * Return: new countdown value 5435 */ 5436 u8 ieee80211_beacon_update_cntdwn(struct ieee80211_vif *vif); 5437 5438 /** 5439 * ieee80211_beacon_set_cntdwn - request mac80211 to set beacon countdown 5440 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback. 5441 * @counter: the new value for the counter 5442 * 5443 * The beacon countdown can be changed by the device, this API should be 5444 * used by the device driver to update csa counter in mac80211. 5445 * 5446 * It should never be used together with ieee80211_beacon_update_cntdwn(), 5447 * as it will cause a race condition around the counter value. 5448 */ 5449 void ieee80211_beacon_set_cntdwn(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, u8 counter); 5450 5451 /** 5452 * ieee80211_csa_finish - notify mac80211 about channel switch 5453 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback. 5454 * 5455 * After a channel switch announcement was scheduled and the counter in this 5456 * announcement hits 1, this function must be called by the driver to 5457 * notify mac80211 that the channel can be changed. 5458 */ 5459 void ieee80211_csa_finish(struct ieee80211_vif *vif); 5460 5461 /** 5462 * ieee80211_beacon_cntdwn_is_complete - find out if countdown reached 1 5463 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback. 5464 * 5465 * This function returns whether the countdown reached zero. 5466 */ 5467 bool ieee80211_beacon_cntdwn_is_complete(struct ieee80211_vif *vif); 5468 5469 /** 5470 * ieee80211_color_change_finish - notify mac80211 about color change 5471 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback. 5472 * 5473 * After a color change announcement was scheduled and the counter in this 5474 * announcement hits 1, this function must be called by the driver to 5475 * notify mac80211 that the color can be changed 5476 */ 5477 void ieee80211_color_change_finish(struct ieee80211_vif *vif); 5478 5479 /** 5480 * ieee80211_proberesp_get - retrieve a Probe Response template 5481 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw(). 5482 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback. 5483 * 5484 * Creates a Probe Response template which can, for example, be uploaded to 5485 * hardware. The destination address should be set by the caller. 5486 * 5487 * Can only be called in AP mode. 5488 * 5489 * Return: The Probe Response template. %NULL on error. 5490 */ 5491 struct sk_buff *ieee80211_proberesp_get(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 5492 struct ieee80211_vif *vif); 5493 5494 /** 5495 * ieee80211_pspoll_get - retrieve a PS Poll template 5496 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw(). 5497 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback. 5498 * 5499 * Creates a PS Poll a template which can, for example, uploaded to 5500 * hardware. The template must be updated after association so that correct 5501 * AID, BSSID and MAC address is used. 5502 * 5503 * Note: Caller (or hardware) is responsible for setting the 5504 * &IEEE80211_FCTL_PM bit. 5505 * 5506 * Return: The PS Poll template. %NULL on error. 5507 */ 5508 struct sk_buff *ieee80211_pspoll_get(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 5509 struct ieee80211_vif *vif); 5510 5511 /** 5512 * ieee80211_nullfunc_get - retrieve a nullfunc template 5513 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw(). 5514 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback. 5515 * @link_id: If the vif is an MLD, get a frame with the link addresses 5516 * for the given link ID. For a link_id < 0 you get a frame with 5517 * MLD addresses, however useful that might be. 5518 * @qos_ok: QoS NDP is acceptable to the caller, this should be set 5519 * if at all possible 5520 * 5521 * Creates a Nullfunc template which can, for example, uploaded to 5522 * hardware. The template must be updated after association so that correct 5523 * BSSID and address is used. 5524 * 5525 * If @qos_ndp is set and the association is to an AP with QoS/WMM, the 5526 * returned packet will be QoS NDP. 5527 * 5528 * Note: Caller (or hardware) is responsible for setting the 5529 * &IEEE80211_FCTL_PM bit as well as Duration and Sequence Control fields. 5530 * 5531 * Return: The nullfunc template. %NULL on error. 5532 */ 5533 struct sk_buff *ieee80211_nullfunc_get(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 5534 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 5535 int link_id, bool qos_ok); 5536 5537 /** 5538 * ieee80211_probereq_get - retrieve a Probe Request template 5539 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw(). 5540 * @src_addr: source MAC address 5541 * @ssid: SSID buffer 5542 * @ssid_len: length of SSID 5543 * @tailroom: tailroom to reserve at end of SKB for IEs 5544 * 5545 * Creates a Probe Request template which can, for example, be uploaded to 5546 * hardware. 5547 * 5548 * Return: The Probe Request template. %NULL on error. 5549 */ 5550 struct sk_buff *ieee80211_probereq_get(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 5551 const u8 *src_addr, 5552 const u8 *ssid, size_t ssid_len, 5553 size_t tailroom); 5554 5555 /** 5556 * ieee80211_rts_get - RTS frame generation function 5557 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw(). 5558 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback. 5559 * @frame: pointer to the frame that is going to be protected by the RTS. 5560 * @frame_len: the frame length (in octets). 5561 * @frame_txctl: &struct ieee80211_tx_info of the frame. 5562 * @rts: The buffer where to store the RTS frame. 5563 * 5564 * If the RTS frames are generated by the host system (i.e., not in 5565 * hardware/firmware), the low-level driver uses this function to receive 5566 * the next RTS frame from the 802.11 code. The low-level is responsible 5567 * for calling this function before and RTS frame is needed. 5568 */ 5569 void ieee80211_rts_get(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 5570 const void *frame, size_t frame_len, 5571 const struct ieee80211_tx_info *frame_txctl, 5572 struct ieee80211_rts *rts); 5573 5574 /** 5575 * ieee80211_rts_duration - Get the duration field for an RTS frame 5576 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw(). 5577 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback. 5578 * @frame_len: the length of the frame that is going to be protected by the RTS. 5579 * @frame_txctl: &struct ieee80211_tx_info of the frame. 5580 * 5581 * If the RTS is generated in firmware, but the host system must provide 5582 * the duration field, the low-level driver uses this function to receive 5583 * the duration field value in little-endian byteorder. 5584 * 5585 * Return: The duration. 5586 */ 5587 __le16 ieee80211_rts_duration(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 5588 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, size_t frame_len, 5589 const struct ieee80211_tx_info *frame_txctl); 5590 5591 /** 5592 * ieee80211_ctstoself_get - CTS-to-self frame generation function 5593 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw(). 5594 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback. 5595 * @frame: pointer to the frame that is going to be protected by the CTS-to-self. 5596 * @frame_len: the frame length (in octets). 5597 * @frame_txctl: &struct ieee80211_tx_info of the frame. 5598 * @cts: The buffer where to store the CTS-to-self frame. 5599 * 5600 * If the CTS-to-self frames are generated by the host system (i.e., not in 5601 * hardware/firmware), the low-level driver uses this function to receive 5602 * the next CTS-to-self frame from the 802.11 code. The low-level is responsible 5603 * for calling this function before and CTS-to-self frame is needed. 5604 */ 5605 void ieee80211_ctstoself_get(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 5606 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 5607 const void *frame, size_t frame_len, 5608 const struct ieee80211_tx_info *frame_txctl, 5609 struct ieee80211_cts *cts); 5610 5611 /** 5612 * ieee80211_ctstoself_duration - Get the duration field for a CTS-to-self frame 5613 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw(). 5614 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback. 5615 * @frame_len: the length of the frame that is going to be protected by the CTS-to-self. 5616 * @frame_txctl: &struct ieee80211_tx_info of the frame. 5617 * 5618 * If the CTS-to-self is generated in firmware, but the host system must provide 5619 * the duration field, the low-level driver uses this function to receive 5620 * the duration field value in little-endian byteorder. 5621 * 5622 * Return: The duration. 5623 */ 5624 __le16 ieee80211_ctstoself_duration(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 5625 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 5626 size_t frame_len, 5627 const struct ieee80211_tx_info *frame_txctl); 5628 5629 /** 5630 * ieee80211_generic_frame_duration - Calculate the duration field for a frame 5631 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw(). 5632 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback. 5633 * @band: the band to calculate the frame duration on 5634 * @frame_len: the length of the frame. 5635 * @rate: the rate at which the frame is going to be transmitted. 5636 * 5637 * Calculate the duration field of some generic frame, given its 5638 * length and transmission rate (in 100kbps). 5639 * 5640 * Return: The duration. 5641 */ 5642 __le16 ieee80211_generic_frame_duration(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 5643 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 5644 enum nl80211_band band, 5645 size_t frame_len, 5646 struct ieee80211_rate *rate); 5647 5648 /** 5649 * ieee80211_get_buffered_bc - accessing buffered broadcast and multicast frames 5650 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw(). 5651 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback. 5652 * 5653 * Function for accessing buffered broadcast and multicast frames. If 5654 * hardware/firmware does not implement buffering of broadcast/multicast 5655 * frames when power saving is used, 802.11 code buffers them in the host 5656 * memory. The low-level driver uses this function to fetch next buffered 5657 * frame. In most cases, this is used when generating beacon frame. 5658 * 5659 * Return: A pointer to the next buffered skb or NULL if no more buffered 5660 * frames are available. 5661 * 5662 * Note: buffered frames are returned only after DTIM beacon frame was 5663 * generated with ieee80211_beacon_get() and the low-level driver must thus 5664 * call ieee80211_beacon_get() first. ieee80211_get_buffered_bc() returns 5665 * NULL if the previous generated beacon was not DTIM, so the low-level driver 5666 * does not need to check for DTIM beacons separately and should be able to 5667 * use common code for all beacons. 5668 */ 5669 struct sk_buff * 5670 ieee80211_get_buffered_bc(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif); 5671 5672 /** 5673 * ieee80211_get_tkip_p1k_iv - get a TKIP phase 1 key for IV32 5674 * 5675 * This function returns the TKIP phase 1 key for the given IV32. 5676 * 5677 * @keyconf: the parameter passed with the set key 5678 * @iv32: IV32 to get the P1K for 5679 * @p1k: a buffer to which the key will be written, as 5 u16 values 5680 */ 5681 void ieee80211_get_tkip_p1k_iv(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf, 5682 u32 iv32, u16 *p1k); 5683 5684 /** 5685 * ieee80211_get_tkip_p1k - get a TKIP phase 1 key 5686 * 5687 * This function returns the TKIP phase 1 key for the IV32 taken 5688 * from the given packet. 5689 * 5690 * @keyconf: the parameter passed with the set key 5691 * @skb: the packet to take the IV32 value from that will be encrypted 5692 * with this P1K 5693 * @p1k: a buffer to which the key will be written, as 5 u16 values 5694 */ 5695 static inline void ieee80211_get_tkip_p1k(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf, 5696 struct sk_buff *skb, u16 *p1k) 5697 { 5698 struct ieee80211_hdr *hdr = (struct ieee80211_hdr *)skb->data; 5699 const u8 *data = (u8 *)hdr + ieee80211_hdrlen(hdr->frame_control); 5700 u32 iv32 = get_unaligned_le32(&data[4]); 5701 5702 ieee80211_get_tkip_p1k_iv(keyconf, iv32, p1k); 5703 } 5704 5705 /** 5706 * ieee80211_get_tkip_rx_p1k - get a TKIP phase 1 key for RX 5707 * 5708 * This function returns the TKIP phase 1 key for the given IV32 5709 * and transmitter address. 5710 * 5711 * @keyconf: the parameter passed with the set key 5712 * @ta: TA that will be used with the key 5713 * @iv32: IV32 to get the P1K for 5714 * @p1k: a buffer to which the key will be written, as 5 u16 values 5715 */ 5716 void ieee80211_get_tkip_rx_p1k(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf, 5717 const u8 *ta, u32 iv32, u16 *p1k); 5718 5719 /** 5720 * ieee80211_get_tkip_p2k - get a TKIP phase 2 key 5721 * 5722 * This function computes the TKIP RC4 key for the IV values 5723 * in the packet. 5724 * 5725 * @keyconf: the parameter passed with the set key 5726 * @skb: the packet to take the IV32/IV16 values from that will be 5727 * encrypted with this key 5728 * @p2k: a buffer to which the key will be written, 16 bytes 5729 */ 5730 void ieee80211_get_tkip_p2k(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf, 5731 struct sk_buff *skb, u8 *p2k); 5732 5733 /** 5734 * ieee80211_tkip_add_iv - write TKIP IV and Ext. IV to pos 5735 * 5736 * @pos: start of crypto header 5737 * @keyconf: the parameter passed with the set key 5738 * @pn: PN to add 5739 * 5740 * Returns: pointer to the octet following IVs (i.e. beginning of 5741 * the packet payload) 5742 * 5743 * This function writes the tkip IV value to pos (which should 5744 * point to the crypto header) 5745 */ 5746 u8 *ieee80211_tkip_add_iv(u8 *pos, struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf, u64 pn); 5747 5748 /** 5749 * ieee80211_get_key_rx_seq - get key RX sequence counter 5750 * 5751 * @keyconf: the parameter passed with the set key 5752 * @tid: The TID, or -1 for the management frame value (CCMP/GCMP only); 5753 * the value on TID 0 is also used for non-QoS frames. For 5754 * CMAC, only TID 0 is valid. 5755 * @seq: buffer to receive the sequence data 5756 * 5757 * This function allows a driver to retrieve the current RX IV/PNs 5758 * for the given key. It must not be called if IV checking is done 5759 * by the device and not by mac80211. 5760 * 5761 * Note that this function may only be called when no RX processing 5762 * can be done concurrently. 5763 */ 5764 void ieee80211_get_key_rx_seq(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf, 5765 int tid, struct ieee80211_key_seq *seq); 5766 5767 /** 5768 * ieee80211_set_key_rx_seq - set key RX sequence counter 5769 * 5770 * @keyconf: the parameter passed with the set key 5771 * @tid: The TID, or -1 for the management frame value (CCMP/GCMP only); 5772 * the value on TID 0 is also used for non-QoS frames. For 5773 * CMAC, only TID 0 is valid. 5774 * @seq: new sequence data 5775 * 5776 * This function allows a driver to set the current RX IV/PNs for the 5777 * given key. This is useful when resuming from WoWLAN sleep and GTK 5778 * rekey may have been done while suspended. It should not be called 5779 * if IV checking is done by the device and not by mac80211. 5780 * 5781 * Note that this function may only be called when no RX processing 5782 * can be done concurrently. 5783 */ 5784 void ieee80211_set_key_rx_seq(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf, 5785 int tid, struct ieee80211_key_seq *seq); 5786 5787 /** 5788 * ieee80211_remove_key - remove the given key 5789 * @keyconf: the parameter passed with the set key 5790 * 5791 * Remove the given key. If the key was uploaded to the hardware at the 5792 * time this function is called, it is not deleted in the hardware but 5793 * instead assumed to have been removed already. 5794 * 5795 * Note that due to locking considerations this function can (currently) 5796 * only be called during key iteration (ieee80211_iter_keys().) 5797 */ 5798 void ieee80211_remove_key(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf); 5799 5800 /** 5801 * ieee80211_gtk_rekey_add - add a GTK key from rekeying during WoWLAN 5802 * @vif: the virtual interface to add the key on 5803 * @keyconf: new key data 5804 * 5805 * When GTK rekeying was done while the system was suspended, (a) new 5806 * key(s) will be available. These will be needed by mac80211 for proper 5807 * RX processing, so this function allows setting them. 5808 * 5809 * The function returns the newly allocated key structure, which will 5810 * have similar contents to the passed key configuration but point to 5811 * mac80211-owned memory. In case of errors, the function returns an 5812 * ERR_PTR(), use IS_ERR() etc. 5813 * 5814 * Note that this function assumes the key isn't added to hardware 5815 * acceleration, so no TX will be done with the key. Since it's a GTK 5816 * on managed (station) networks, this is true anyway. If the driver 5817 * calls this function from the resume callback and subsequently uses 5818 * the return code 1 to reconfigure the device, this key will be part 5819 * of the reconfiguration. 5820 * 5821 * Note that the driver should also call ieee80211_set_key_rx_seq() 5822 * for the new key for each TID to set up sequence counters properly. 5823 * 5824 * IMPORTANT: If this replaces a key that is present in the hardware, 5825 * then it will attempt to remove it during this call. In many cases 5826 * this isn't what you want, so call ieee80211_remove_key() first for 5827 * the key that's being replaced. 5828 */ 5829 struct ieee80211_key_conf * 5830 ieee80211_gtk_rekey_add(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 5831 struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf); 5832 5833 /** 5834 * ieee80211_gtk_rekey_notify - notify userspace supplicant of rekeying 5835 * @vif: virtual interface the rekeying was done on 5836 * @bssid: The BSSID of the AP, for checking association 5837 * @replay_ctr: the new replay counter after GTK rekeying 5838 * @gfp: allocation flags 5839 */ 5840 void ieee80211_gtk_rekey_notify(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, const u8 *bssid, 5841 const u8 *replay_ctr, gfp_t gfp); 5842 5843 /** 5844 * ieee80211_key_mic_failure - increment MIC failure counter for the key 5845 * 5846 * Note: this is really only safe if no other RX function is called 5847 * at the same time. 5848 * 5849 * @keyconf: the key in question 5850 */ 5851 void ieee80211_key_mic_failure(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf); 5852 5853 /** 5854 * ieee80211_key_replay - increment replay counter for the key 5855 * 5856 * Note: this is really only safe if no other RX function is called 5857 * at the same time. 5858 * 5859 * @keyconf: the key in question 5860 */ 5861 void ieee80211_key_replay(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf); 5862 5863 /** 5864 * ieee80211_wake_queue - wake specific queue 5865 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw(). 5866 * @queue: queue number (counted from zero). 5867 * 5868 * Drivers must use this function instead of netif_wake_queue. 5869 */ 5870 void ieee80211_wake_queue(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, int queue); 5871 5872 /** 5873 * ieee80211_stop_queue - stop specific queue 5874 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw(). 5875 * @queue: queue number (counted from zero). 5876 * 5877 * Drivers must use this function instead of netif_stop_queue. 5878 */ 5879 void ieee80211_stop_queue(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, int queue); 5880 5881 /** 5882 * ieee80211_queue_stopped - test status of the queue 5883 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw(). 5884 * @queue: queue number (counted from zero). 5885 * 5886 * Drivers must use this function instead of netif_queue_stopped. 5887 * 5888 * Return: %true if the queue is stopped. %false otherwise. 5889 */ 5890 5891 int ieee80211_queue_stopped(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, int queue); 5892 5893 /** 5894 * ieee80211_stop_queues - stop all queues 5895 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw(). 5896 * 5897 * Drivers must use this function instead of netif_tx_stop_all_queues. 5898 */ 5899 void ieee80211_stop_queues(struct ieee80211_hw *hw); 5900 5901 /** 5902 * ieee80211_wake_queues - wake all queues 5903 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw(). 5904 * 5905 * Drivers must use this function instead of netif_tx_wake_all_queues. 5906 */ 5907 void ieee80211_wake_queues(struct ieee80211_hw *hw); 5908 5909 /** 5910 * ieee80211_scan_completed - completed hardware scan 5911 * 5912 * When hardware scan offload is used (i.e. the hw_scan() callback is 5913 * assigned) this function needs to be called by the driver to notify 5914 * mac80211 that the scan finished. This function can be called from 5915 * any context, including hardirq context. 5916 * 5917 * @hw: the hardware that finished the scan 5918 * @info: information about the completed scan 5919 */ 5920 void ieee80211_scan_completed(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 5921 struct cfg80211_scan_info *info); 5922 5923 /** 5924 * ieee80211_sched_scan_results - got results from scheduled scan 5925 * 5926 * When a scheduled scan is running, this function needs to be called by the 5927 * driver whenever there are new scan results available. 5928 * 5929 * @hw: the hardware that is performing scheduled scans 5930 */ 5931 void ieee80211_sched_scan_results(struct ieee80211_hw *hw); 5932 5933 /** 5934 * ieee80211_sched_scan_stopped - inform that the scheduled scan has stopped 5935 * 5936 * When a scheduled scan is running, this function can be called by 5937 * the driver if it needs to stop the scan to perform another task. 5938 * Usual scenarios are drivers that cannot continue the scheduled scan 5939 * while associating, for instance. 5940 * 5941 * @hw: the hardware that is performing scheduled scans 5942 */ 5943 void ieee80211_sched_scan_stopped(struct ieee80211_hw *hw); 5944 5945 /** 5946 * enum ieee80211_interface_iteration_flags - interface iteration flags 5947 * @IEEE80211_IFACE_ITER_NORMAL: Iterate over all interfaces that have 5948 * been added to the driver; However, note that during hardware 5949 * reconfiguration (after restart_hw) it will iterate over a new 5950 * interface and over all the existing interfaces even if they 5951 * haven't been re-added to the driver yet. 5952 * @IEEE80211_IFACE_ITER_RESUME_ALL: During resume, iterate over all 5953 * interfaces, even if they haven't been re-added to the driver yet. 5954 * @IEEE80211_IFACE_ITER_ACTIVE: Iterate only active interfaces (netdev is up). 5955 * @IEEE80211_IFACE_SKIP_SDATA_NOT_IN_DRIVER: Skip any interfaces where SDATA 5956 * is not in the driver. This may fix crashes during firmware recovery 5957 * for instance. 5958 */ 5959 enum ieee80211_interface_iteration_flags { 5960 IEEE80211_IFACE_ITER_NORMAL = 0, 5961 IEEE80211_IFACE_ITER_RESUME_ALL = BIT(0), 5962 IEEE80211_IFACE_ITER_ACTIVE = BIT(1), 5963 IEEE80211_IFACE_SKIP_SDATA_NOT_IN_DRIVER = BIT(2), 5964 }; 5965 5966 /** 5967 * ieee80211_iterate_interfaces - iterate interfaces 5968 * 5969 * This function iterates over the interfaces associated with a given 5970 * hardware and calls the callback for them. This includes active as well as 5971 * inactive interfaces. This function allows the iterator function to sleep. 5972 * Will iterate over a new interface during add_interface(). 5973 * 5974 * @hw: the hardware struct of which the interfaces should be iterated over 5975 * @iter_flags: iteration flags, see &enum ieee80211_interface_iteration_flags 5976 * @iterator: the iterator function to call 5977 * @data: first argument of the iterator function 5978 */ 5979 void ieee80211_iterate_interfaces(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u32 iter_flags, 5980 void (*iterator)(void *data, u8 *mac, 5981 struct ieee80211_vif *vif), 5982 void *data); 5983 5984 /** 5985 * ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces - iterate active interfaces 5986 * 5987 * This function iterates over the interfaces associated with a given 5988 * hardware that are currently active and calls the callback for them. 5989 * This function allows the iterator function to sleep, when the iterator 5990 * function is atomic @ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces_atomic can 5991 * be used. 5992 * Does not iterate over a new interface during add_interface(). 5993 * 5994 * @hw: the hardware struct of which the interfaces should be iterated over 5995 * @iter_flags: iteration flags, see &enum ieee80211_interface_iteration_flags 5996 * @iterator: the iterator function to call 5997 * @data: first argument of the iterator function 5998 */ 5999 static inline void 6000 ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u32 iter_flags, 6001 void (*iterator)(void *data, u8 *mac, 6002 struct ieee80211_vif *vif), 6003 void *data) 6004 { 6005 ieee80211_iterate_interfaces(hw, 6006 iter_flags | IEEE80211_IFACE_ITER_ACTIVE, 6007 iterator, data); 6008 } 6009 6010 /** 6011 * ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces_atomic - iterate active interfaces 6012 * 6013 * This function iterates over the interfaces associated with a given 6014 * hardware that are currently active and calls the callback for them. 6015 * This function requires the iterator callback function to be atomic, 6016 * if that is not desired, use @ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces instead. 6017 * Does not iterate over a new interface during add_interface(). 6018 * 6019 * @hw: the hardware struct of which the interfaces should be iterated over 6020 * @iter_flags: iteration flags, see &enum ieee80211_interface_iteration_flags 6021 * @iterator: the iterator function to call, cannot sleep 6022 * @data: first argument of the iterator function 6023 */ 6024 void ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces_atomic(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 6025 u32 iter_flags, 6026 void (*iterator)(void *data, 6027 u8 *mac, 6028 struct ieee80211_vif *vif), 6029 void *data); 6030 6031 /** 6032 * ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces_mtx - iterate active interfaces 6033 * 6034 * This function iterates over the interfaces associated with a given 6035 * hardware that are currently active and calls the callback for them. 6036 * This version can only be used while holding the wiphy mutex. 6037 * 6038 * @hw: the hardware struct of which the interfaces should be iterated over 6039 * @iter_flags: iteration flags, see &enum ieee80211_interface_iteration_flags 6040 * @iterator: the iterator function to call, cannot sleep 6041 * @data: first argument of the iterator function 6042 */ 6043 void ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces_mtx(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 6044 u32 iter_flags, 6045 void (*iterator)(void *data, 6046 u8 *mac, 6047 struct ieee80211_vif *vif), 6048 void *data); 6049 6050 /** 6051 * ieee80211_iterate_stations_atomic - iterate stations 6052 * 6053 * This function iterates over all stations associated with a given 6054 * hardware that are currently uploaded to the driver and calls the callback 6055 * function for them. 6056 * This function requires the iterator callback function to be atomic, 6057 * 6058 * @hw: the hardware struct of which the interfaces should be iterated over 6059 * @iterator: the iterator function to call, cannot sleep 6060 * @data: first argument of the iterator function 6061 */ 6062 void ieee80211_iterate_stations_atomic(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 6063 void (*iterator)(void *data, 6064 struct ieee80211_sta *sta), 6065 void *data); 6066 /** 6067 * ieee80211_queue_work - add work onto the mac80211 workqueue 6068 * 6069 * Drivers and mac80211 use this to add work onto the mac80211 workqueue. 6070 * This helper ensures drivers are not queueing work when they should not be. 6071 * 6072 * @hw: the hardware struct for the interface we are adding work for 6073 * @work: the work we want to add onto the mac80211 workqueue 6074 */ 6075 void ieee80211_queue_work(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct work_struct *work); 6076 6077 /** 6078 * ieee80211_queue_delayed_work - add work onto the mac80211 workqueue 6079 * 6080 * Drivers and mac80211 use this to queue delayed work onto the mac80211 6081 * workqueue. 6082 * 6083 * @hw: the hardware struct for the interface we are adding work for 6084 * @dwork: delayable work to queue onto the mac80211 workqueue 6085 * @delay: number of jiffies to wait before queueing 6086 */ 6087 void ieee80211_queue_delayed_work(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 6088 struct delayed_work *dwork, 6089 unsigned long delay); 6090 6091 /** 6092 * ieee80211_refresh_tx_agg_session_timer - Refresh a tx agg session timer. 6093 * @sta: the station for which to start a BA session 6094 * @tid: the TID to BA on. 6095 * 6096 * This function allows low level driver to refresh tx agg session timer 6097 * to maintain BA session, the session level will still be managed by the 6098 * mac80211. 6099 * 6100 * Note: must be called in an RCU critical section. 6101 */ 6102 void ieee80211_refresh_tx_agg_session_timer(struct ieee80211_sta *sta, 6103 u16 tid); 6104 6105 /** 6106 * ieee80211_start_tx_ba_session - Start a tx Block Ack session. 6107 * @sta: the station for which to start a BA session 6108 * @tid: the TID to BA on. 6109 * @timeout: session timeout value (in TUs) 6110 * 6111 * Return: success if addBA request was sent, failure otherwise 6112 * 6113 * Although mac80211/low level driver/user space application can estimate 6114 * the need to start aggregation on a certain RA/TID, the session level 6115 * will be managed by the mac80211. 6116 */ 6117 int ieee80211_start_tx_ba_session(struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u16 tid, 6118 u16 timeout); 6119 6120 /** 6121 * ieee80211_start_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe - low level driver ready to aggregate. 6122 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback 6123 * @ra: receiver address of the BA session recipient. 6124 * @tid: the TID to BA on. 6125 * 6126 * This function must be called by low level driver once it has 6127 * finished with preparations for the BA session. It can be called 6128 * from any context. 6129 */ 6130 void ieee80211_start_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, const u8 *ra, 6131 u16 tid); 6132 6133 /** 6134 * ieee80211_stop_tx_ba_session - Stop a Block Ack session. 6135 * @sta: the station whose BA session to stop 6136 * @tid: the TID to stop BA. 6137 * 6138 * Return: negative error if the TID is invalid, or no aggregation active 6139 * 6140 * Although mac80211/low level driver/user space application can estimate 6141 * the need to stop aggregation on a certain RA/TID, the session level 6142 * will be managed by the mac80211. 6143 */ 6144 int ieee80211_stop_tx_ba_session(struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u16 tid); 6145 6146 /** 6147 * ieee80211_stop_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe - low level driver ready to stop aggregate. 6148 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback 6149 * @ra: receiver address of the BA session recipient. 6150 * @tid: the desired TID to BA on. 6151 * 6152 * This function must be called by low level driver once it has 6153 * finished with preparations for the BA session tear down. It 6154 * can be called from any context. 6155 */ 6156 void ieee80211_stop_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, const u8 *ra, 6157 u16 tid); 6158 6159 /** 6160 * ieee80211_find_sta - find a station 6161 * 6162 * @vif: virtual interface to look for station on 6163 * @addr: station's address 6164 * 6165 * Return: The station, if found. %NULL otherwise. 6166 * 6167 * Note: This function must be called under RCU lock and the 6168 * resulting pointer is only valid under RCU lock as well. 6169 */ 6170 struct ieee80211_sta *ieee80211_find_sta(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 6171 const u8 *addr); 6172 6173 /** 6174 * ieee80211_find_sta_by_ifaddr - find a station on hardware 6175 * 6176 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw() 6177 * @addr: remote station's address 6178 * @localaddr: local address (vif->sdata->vif.addr). Use NULL for 'any'. 6179 * 6180 * Return: The station, if found. %NULL otherwise. 6181 * 6182 * Note: This function must be called under RCU lock and the 6183 * resulting pointer is only valid under RCU lock as well. 6184 * 6185 * NOTE: You may pass NULL for localaddr, but then you will just get 6186 * the first STA that matches the remote address 'addr'. 6187 * We can have multiple STA associated with multiple 6188 * logical stations (e.g. consider a station connecting to another 6189 * BSSID on the same AP hardware without disconnecting first). 6190 * In this case, the result of this method with localaddr NULL 6191 * is not reliable. 6192 * 6193 * DO NOT USE THIS FUNCTION with localaddr NULL if at all possible. 6194 */ 6195 struct ieee80211_sta *ieee80211_find_sta_by_ifaddr(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 6196 const u8 *addr, 6197 const u8 *localaddr); 6198 6199 /** 6200 * ieee80211_find_sta_by_link_addrs - find STA by link addresses 6201 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw() 6202 * @addr: remote station's link address 6203 * @localaddr: local link address, use %NULL for any (but avoid that) 6204 * @link_id: pointer to obtain the link ID if the STA is found, 6205 * may be %NULL if the link ID is not needed 6206 * 6207 * Obtain the STA by link address, must use RCU protection. 6208 */ 6209 struct ieee80211_sta * 6210 ieee80211_find_sta_by_link_addrs(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 6211 const u8 *addr, 6212 const u8 *localaddr, 6213 unsigned int *link_id); 6214 6215 /** 6216 * ieee80211_sta_block_awake - block station from waking up 6217 * @hw: the hardware 6218 * @pubsta: the station 6219 * @block: whether to block or unblock 6220 * 6221 * Some devices require that all frames that are on the queues 6222 * for a specific station that went to sleep are flushed before 6223 * a poll response or frames after the station woke up can be 6224 * delivered to that it. Note that such frames must be rejected 6225 * by the driver as filtered, with the appropriate status flag. 6226 * 6227 * This function allows implementing this mode in a race-free 6228 * manner. 6229 * 6230 * To do this, a driver must keep track of the number of frames 6231 * still enqueued for a specific station. If this number is not 6232 * zero when the station goes to sleep, the driver must call 6233 * this function to force mac80211 to consider the station to 6234 * be asleep regardless of the station's actual state. Once the 6235 * number of outstanding frames reaches zero, the driver must 6236 * call this function again to unblock the station. That will 6237 * cause mac80211 to be able to send ps-poll responses, and if 6238 * the station queried in the meantime then frames will also 6239 * be sent out as a result of this. Additionally, the driver 6240 * will be notified that the station woke up some time after 6241 * it is unblocked, regardless of whether the station actually 6242 * woke up while blocked or not. 6243 */ 6244 void ieee80211_sta_block_awake(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 6245 struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta, bool block); 6246 6247 /** 6248 * ieee80211_sta_eosp - notify mac80211 about end of SP 6249 * @pubsta: the station 6250 * 6251 * When a device transmits frames in a way that it can't tell 6252 * mac80211 in the TX status about the EOSP, it must clear the 6253 * %IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP bit and call this function instead. 6254 * This applies for PS-Poll as well as uAPSD. 6255 * 6256 * Note that just like with _tx_status() and _rx() drivers must 6257 * not mix calls to irqsafe/non-irqsafe versions, this function 6258 * must not be mixed with those either. Use the all irqsafe, or 6259 * all non-irqsafe, don't mix! 6260 * 6261 * NB: the _irqsafe version of this function doesn't exist, no 6262 * driver needs it right now. Don't call this function if 6263 * you'd need the _irqsafe version, look at the git history 6264 * and restore the _irqsafe version! 6265 */ 6266 void ieee80211_sta_eosp(struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta); 6267 6268 /** 6269 * ieee80211_send_eosp_nullfunc - ask mac80211 to send NDP with EOSP 6270 * @pubsta: the station 6271 * @tid: the tid of the NDP 6272 * 6273 * Sometimes the device understands that it needs to close 6274 * the Service Period unexpectedly. This can happen when 6275 * sending frames that are filling holes in the BA window. 6276 * In this case, the device can ask mac80211 to send a 6277 * Nullfunc frame with EOSP set. When that happens, the 6278 * driver must have called ieee80211_sta_set_buffered() to 6279 * let mac80211 know that there are no buffered frames any 6280 * more, otherwise mac80211 will get the more_data bit wrong. 6281 * The low level driver must have made sure that the frame 6282 * will be sent despite the station being in power-save. 6283 * Mac80211 won't call allow_buffered_frames(). 6284 * Note that calling this function, doesn't exempt the driver 6285 * from closing the EOSP properly, it will still have to call 6286 * ieee80211_sta_eosp when the NDP is sent. 6287 */ 6288 void ieee80211_send_eosp_nullfunc(struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta, int tid); 6289 6290 /** 6291 * ieee80211_sta_recalc_aggregates - recalculate aggregate data after a change 6292 * @pubsta: the station 6293 * 6294 * Call this function after changing a per-link aggregate data as referenced in 6295 * &struct ieee80211_sta_aggregates by accessing the agg field of 6296 * &struct ieee80211_link_sta. 6297 * 6298 * With non MLO the data in deflink will be referenced directly. In that case 6299 * there is no need to call this function. 6300 */ 6301 void ieee80211_sta_recalc_aggregates(struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta); 6302 6303 /** 6304 * ieee80211_sta_register_airtime - register airtime usage for a sta/tid 6305 * 6306 * Register airtime usage for a given sta on a given tid. The driver must call 6307 * this function to notify mac80211 that a station used a certain amount of 6308 * airtime. This information will be used by the TXQ scheduler to schedule 6309 * stations in a way that ensures airtime fairness. 6310 * 6311 * The reported airtime should as a minimum include all time that is spent 6312 * transmitting to the remote station, including overhead and padding, but not 6313 * including time spent waiting for a TXOP. If the time is not reported by the 6314 * hardware it can in some cases be calculated from the rate and known frame 6315 * composition. When possible, the time should include any failed transmission 6316 * attempts. 6317 * 6318 * The driver can either call this function synchronously for every packet or 6319 * aggregate, or asynchronously as airtime usage information becomes available. 6320 * TX and RX airtime can be reported together, or separately by setting one of 6321 * them to 0. 6322 * 6323 * @pubsta: the station 6324 * @tid: the TID to register airtime for 6325 * @tx_airtime: airtime used during TX (in usec) 6326 * @rx_airtime: airtime used during RX (in usec) 6327 */ 6328 void ieee80211_sta_register_airtime(struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta, u8 tid, 6329 u32 tx_airtime, u32 rx_airtime); 6330 6331 /** 6332 * ieee80211_txq_airtime_check - check if a txq can send frame to device 6333 * 6334 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw() 6335 * @txq: pointer obtained from station or virtual interface 6336 * 6337 * Return true if the AQL's airtime limit has not been reached and the txq can 6338 * continue to send more packets to the device. Otherwise return false. 6339 */ 6340 bool 6341 ieee80211_txq_airtime_check(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_txq *txq); 6342 6343 /** 6344 * ieee80211_iter_keys - iterate keys programmed into the device 6345 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw() 6346 * @vif: virtual interface to iterate, may be %NULL for all 6347 * @iter: iterator function that will be called for each key 6348 * @iter_data: custom data to pass to the iterator function 6349 * 6350 * This function can be used to iterate all the keys known to 6351 * mac80211, even those that weren't previously programmed into 6352 * the device. This is intended for use in WoWLAN if the device 6353 * needs reprogramming of the keys during suspend. Note that due 6354 * to locking reasons, it is also only safe to call this at few 6355 * spots since it must hold the RTNL and be able to sleep. 6356 * 6357 * The order in which the keys are iterated matches the order 6358 * in which they were originally installed and handed to the 6359 * set_key callback. 6360 */ 6361 void ieee80211_iter_keys(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 6362 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 6363 void (*iter)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 6364 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 6365 struct ieee80211_sta *sta, 6366 struct ieee80211_key_conf *key, 6367 void *data), 6368 void *iter_data); 6369 6370 /** 6371 * ieee80211_iter_keys_rcu - iterate keys programmed into the device 6372 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw() 6373 * @vif: virtual interface to iterate, may be %NULL for all 6374 * @iter: iterator function that will be called for each key 6375 * @iter_data: custom data to pass to the iterator function 6376 * 6377 * This function can be used to iterate all the keys known to 6378 * mac80211, even those that weren't previously programmed into 6379 * the device. Note that due to locking reasons, keys of station 6380 * in removal process will be skipped. 6381 * 6382 * This function requires being called in an RCU critical section, 6383 * and thus iter must be atomic. 6384 */ 6385 void ieee80211_iter_keys_rcu(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 6386 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 6387 void (*iter)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 6388 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 6389 struct ieee80211_sta *sta, 6390 struct ieee80211_key_conf *key, 6391 void *data), 6392 void *iter_data); 6393 6394 /** 6395 * ieee80211_iter_chan_contexts_atomic - iterate channel contexts 6396 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw(). 6397 * @iter: iterator function 6398 * @iter_data: data passed to iterator function 6399 * 6400 * Iterate all active channel contexts. This function is atomic and 6401 * doesn't acquire any locks internally that might be held in other 6402 * places while calling into the driver. 6403 * 6404 * The iterator will not find a context that's being added (during 6405 * the driver callback to add it) but will find it while it's being 6406 * removed. 6407 * 6408 * Note that during hardware restart, all contexts that existed 6409 * before the restart are considered already present so will be 6410 * found while iterating, whether they've been re-added already 6411 * or not. 6412 */ 6413 void ieee80211_iter_chan_contexts_atomic( 6414 struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 6415 void (*iter)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 6416 struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *chanctx_conf, 6417 void *data), 6418 void *iter_data); 6419 6420 /** 6421 * ieee80211_ap_probereq_get - retrieve a Probe Request template 6422 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw(). 6423 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback. 6424 * 6425 * Creates a Probe Request template which can, for example, be uploaded to 6426 * hardware. The template is filled with bssid, ssid and supported rate 6427 * information. This function must only be called from within the 6428 * .bss_info_changed callback function and only in managed mode. The function 6429 * is only useful when the interface is associated, otherwise it will return 6430 * %NULL. 6431 * 6432 * Return: The Probe Request template. %NULL on error. 6433 */ 6434 struct sk_buff *ieee80211_ap_probereq_get(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 6435 struct ieee80211_vif *vif); 6436 6437 /** 6438 * ieee80211_beacon_loss - inform hardware does not receive beacons 6439 * 6440 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback. 6441 * 6442 * When beacon filtering is enabled with %IEEE80211_VIF_BEACON_FILTER and 6443 * %IEEE80211_CONF_PS is set, the driver needs to inform whenever the 6444 * hardware is not receiving beacons with this function. 6445 */ 6446 void ieee80211_beacon_loss(struct ieee80211_vif *vif); 6447 6448 /** 6449 * ieee80211_connection_loss - inform hardware has lost connection to the AP 6450 * 6451 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback. 6452 * 6453 * When beacon filtering is enabled with %IEEE80211_VIF_BEACON_FILTER, and 6454 * %IEEE80211_CONF_PS and %IEEE80211_HW_CONNECTION_MONITOR are set, the driver 6455 * needs to inform if the connection to the AP has been lost. 6456 * The function may also be called if the connection needs to be terminated 6457 * for some other reason, even if %IEEE80211_HW_CONNECTION_MONITOR isn't set. 6458 * 6459 * This function will cause immediate change to disassociated state, 6460 * without connection recovery attempts. 6461 */ 6462 void ieee80211_connection_loss(struct ieee80211_vif *vif); 6463 6464 /** 6465 * ieee80211_disconnect - request disconnection 6466 * 6467 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback. 6468 * @reconnect: immediate reconnect is desired 6469 * 6470 * Request disconnection from the current network and, if enabled, send a 6471 * hint to the higher layers that immediate reconnect is desired. 6472 */ 6473 void ieee80211_disconnect(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, bool reconnect); 6474 6475 /** 6476 * ieee80211_resume_disconnect - disconnect from AP after resume 6477 * 6478 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback. 6479 * 6480 * Instructs mac80211 to disconnect from the AP after resume. 6481 * Drivers can use this after WoWLAN if they know that the 6482 * connection cannot be kept up, for example because keys were 6483 * used while the device was asleep but the replay counters or 6484 * similar cannot be retrieved from the device during resume. 6485 * 6486 * Note that due to implementation issues, if the driver uses 6487 * the reconfiguration functionality during resume the interface 6488 * will still be added as associated first during resume and then 6489 * disconnect normally later. 6490 * 6491 * This function can only be called from the resume callback and 6492 * the driver must not be holding any of its own locks while it 6493 * calls this function, or at least not any locks it needs in the 6494 * key configuration paths (if it supports HW crypto). 6495 */ 6496 void ieee80211_resume_disconnect(struct ieee80211_vif *vif); 6497 6498 /** 6499 * ieee80211_hw_restart_disconnect - disconnect from AP after 6500 * hardware restart 6501 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback. 6502 * 6503 * Instructs mac80211 to disconnect from the AP after 6504 * hardware restart. 6505 */ 6506 void ieee80211_hw_restart_disconnect(struct ieee80211_vif *vif); 6507 6508 /** 6509 * ieee80211_cqm_rssi_notify - inform a configured connection quality monitoring 6510 * rssi threshold triggered 6511 * 6512 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback. 6513 * @rssi_event: the RSSI trigger event type 6514 * @rssi_level: new RSSI level value or 0 if not available 6515 * @gfp: context flags 6516 * 6517 * When the %IEEE80211_VIF_SUPPORTS_CQM_RSSI is set, and a connection quality 6518 * monitoring is configured with an rssi threshold, the driver will inform 6519 * whenever the rssi level reaches the threshold. 6520 */ 6521 void ieee80211_cqm_rssi_notify(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 6522 enum nl80211_cqm_rssi_threshold_event rssi_event, 6523 s32 rssi_level, 6524 gfp_t gfp); 6525 6526 /** 6527 * ieee80211_cqm_beacon_loss_notify - inform CQM of beacon loss 6528 * 6529 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback. 6530 * @gfp: context flags 6531 */ 6532 void ieee80211_cqm_beacon_loss_notify(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, gfp_t gfp); 6533 6534 /** 6535 * ieee80211_radar_detected - inform that a radar was detected 6536 * 6537 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw() 6538 */ 6539 void ieee80211_radar_detected(struct ieee80211_hw *hw); 6540 6541 /** 6542 * ieee80211_chswitch_done - Complete channel switch process 6543 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback. 6544 * @success: make the channel switch successful or not 6545 * 6546 * Complete the channel switch post-process: set the new operational channel 6547 * and wake up the suspended queues. 6548 */ 6549 void ieee80211_chswitch_done(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, bool success); 6550 6551 /** 6552 * ieee80211_channel_switch_disconnect - disconnect due to channel switch error 6553 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback. 6554 * @block_tx: if %true, do not send deauth frame. 6555 * 6556 * Instruct mac80211 to disconnect due to a channel switch error. The channel 6557 * switch can request to block the tx and so, we need to make sure we do not send 6558 * a deauth frame in this case. 6559 */ 6560 void ieee80211_channel_switch_disconnect(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 6561 bool block_tx); 6562 6563 /** 6564 * ieee80211_request_smps - request SM PS transition 6565 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback. 6566 * @link_id: link ID for MLO, or 0 6567 * @smps_mode: new SM PS mode 6568 * 6569 * This allows the driver to request an SM PS transition in managed 6570 * mode. This is useful when the driver has more information than 6571 * the stack about possible interference, for example by bluetooth. 6572 */ 6573 void ieee80211_request_smps(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, unsigned int link_id, 6574 enum ieee80211_smps_mode smps_mode); 6575 6576 /** 6577 * ieee80211_ready_on_channel - notification of remain-on-channel start 6578 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw() 6579 */ 6580 void ieee80211_ready_on_channel(struct ieee80211_hw *hw); 6581 6582 /** 6583 * ieee80211_remain_on_channel_expired - remain_on_channel duration expired 6584 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw() 6585 */ 6586 void ieee80211_remain_on_channel_expired(struct ieee80211_hw *hw); 6587 6588 /** 6589 * ieee80211_stop_rx_ba_session - callback to stop existing BA sessions 6590 * 6591 * in order not to harm the system performance and user experience, the device 6592 * may request not to allow any rx ba session and tear down existing rx ba 6593 * sessions based on system constraints such as periodic BT activity that needs 6594 * to limit wlan activity (eg.sco or a2dp)." 6595 * in such cases, the intention is to limit the duration of the rx ppdu and 6596 * therefore prevent the peer device to use a-mpdu aggregation. 6597 * 6598 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback. 6599 * @ba_rx_bitmap: Bit map of open rx ba per tid 6600 * @addr: & to bssid mac address 6601 */ 6602 void ieee80211_stop_rx_ba_session(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, u16 ba_rx_bitmap, 6603 const u8 *addr); 6604 6605 /** 6606 * ieee80211_mark_rx_ba_filtered_frames - move RX BA window and mark filtered 6607 * @pubsta: station struct 6608 * @tid: the session's TID 6609 * @ssn: starting sequence number of the bitmap, all frames before this are 6610 * assumed to be out of the window after the call 6611 * @filtered: bitmap of filtered frames, BIT(0) is the @ssn entry etc. 6612 * @received_mpdus: number of received mpdus in firmware 6613 * 6614 * This function moves the BA window and releases all frames before @ssn, and 6615 * marks frames marked in the bitmap as having been filtered. Afterwards, it 6616 * checks if any frames in the window starting from @ssn can now be released 6617 * (in case they were only waiting for frames that were filtered.) 6618 * (Only work correctly if @max_rx_aggregation_subframes <= 64 frames) 6619 */ 6620 void ieee80211_mark_rx_ba_filtered_frames(struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta, u8 tid, 6621 u16 ssn, u64 filtered, 6622 u16 received_mpdus); 6623 6624 /** 6625 * ieee80211_send_bar - send a BlockAckReq frame 6626 * 6627 * can be used to flush pending frames from the peer's aggregation reorder 6628 * buffer. 6629 * 6630 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback. 6631 * @ra: the peer's destination address 6632 * @tid: the TID of the aggregation session 6633 * @ssn: the new starting sequence number for the receiver 6634 */ 6635 void ieee80211_send_bar(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, u8 *ra, u16 tid, u16 ssn); 6636 6637 /** 6638 * ieee80211_manage_rx_ba_offl - helper to queue an RX BA work 6639 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback 6640 * @addr: station mac address 6641 * @tid: the rx tid 6642 */ 6643 void ieee80211_manage_rx_ba_offl(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, const u8 *addr, 6644 unsigned int tid); 6645 6646 /** 6647 * ieee80211_start_rx_ba_session_offl - start a Rx BA session 6648 * 6649 * Some device drivers may offload part of the Rx aggregation flow including 6650 * AddBa/DelBa negotiation but may otherwise be incapable of full Rx 6651 * reordering. 6652 * 6653 * Create structures responsible for reordering so device drivers may call here 6654 * when they complete AddBa negotiation. 6655 * 6656 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback 6657 * @addr: station mac address 6658 * @tid: the rx tid 6659 */ 6660 static inline void ieee80211_start_rx_ba_session_offl(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 6661 const u8 *addr, u16 tid) 6662 { 6663 if (WARN_ON(tid >= IEEE80211_NUM_TIDS)) 6664 return; 6665 ieee80211_manage_rx_ba_offl(vif, addr, tid); 6666 } 6667 6668 /** 6669 * ieee80211_stop_rx_ba_session_offl - stop a Rx BA session 6670 * 6671 * Some device drivers may offload part of the Rx aggregation flow including 6672 * AddBa/DelBa negotiation but may otherwise be incapable of full Rx 6673 * reordering. 6674 * 6675 * Destroy structures responsible for reordering so device drivers may call here 6676 * when they complete DelBa negotiation. 6677 * 6678 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback 6679 * @addr: station mac address 6680 * @tid: the rx tid 6681 */ 6682 static inline void ieee80211_stop_rx_ba_session_offl(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 6683 const u8 *addr, u16 tid) 6684 { 6685 if (WARN_ON(tid >= IEEE80211_NUM_TIDS)) 6686 return; 6687 ieee80211_manage_rx_ba_offl(vif, addr, tid + IEEE80211_NUM_TIDS); 6688 } 6689 6690 /** 6691 * ieee80211_rx_ba_timer_expired - stop a Rx BA session due to timeout 6692 * 6693 * Some device drivers do not offload AddBa/DelBa negotiation, but handle rx 6694 * buffer reording internally, and therefore also handle the session timer. 6695 * 6696 * Trigger the timeout flow, which sends a DelBa. 6697 * 6698 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback 6699 * @addr: station mac address 6700 * @tid: the rx tid 6701 */ 6702 void ieee80211_rx_ba_timer_expired(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 6703 const u8 *addr, unsigned int tid); 6704 6705 /* Rate control API */ 6706 6707 /** 6708 * struct ieee80211_tx_rate_control - rate control information for/from RC algo 6709 * 6710 * @hw: The hardware the algorithm is invoked for. 6711 * @sband: The band this frame is being transmitted on. 6712 * @bss_conf: the current BSS configuration 6713 * @skb: the skb that will be transmitted, the control information in it needs 6714 * to be filled in 6715 * @reported_rate: The rate control algorithm can fill this in to indicate 6716 * which rate should be reported to userspace as the current rate and 6717 * used for rate calculations in the mesh network. 6718 * @rts: whether RTS will be used for this frame because it is longer than the 6719 * RTS threshold 6720 * @short_preamble: whether mac80211 will request short-preamble transmission 6721 * if the selected rate supports it 6722 * @rate_idx_mask: user-requested (legacy) rate mask 6723 * @rate_idx_mcs_mask: user-requested MCS rate mask (NULL if not in use) 6724 * @bss: whether this frame is sent out in AP or IBSS mode 6725 */ 6726 struct ieee80211_tx_rate_control { 6727 struct ieee80211_hw *hw; 6728 struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband; 6729 struct ieee80211_bss_conf *bss_conf; 6730 struct sk_buff *skb; 6731 struct ieee80211_tx_rate reported_rate; 6732 bool rts, short_preamble; 6733 u32 rate_idx_mask; 6734 u8 *rate_idx_mcs_mask; 6735 bool bss; 6736 }; 6737 6738 /** 6739 * enum rate_control_capabilities - rate control capabilities 6740 */ 6741 enum rate_control_capabilities { 6742 /** 6743 * @RATE_CTRL_CAPA_VHT_EXT_NSS_BW: 6744 * Support for extended NSS BW support (dot11VHTExtendedNSSCapable) 6745 * Note that this is only looked at if the minimum number of chains 6746 * that the AP uses is < the number of TX chains the hardware has, 6747 * otherwise the NSS difference doesn't bother us. 6748 */ 6749 RATE_CTRL_CAPA_VHT_EXT_NSS_BW = BIT(0), 6750 /** 6751 * @RATE_CTRL_CAPA_AMPDU_TRIGGER: 6752 * mac80211 should start A-MPDU sessions on tx 6753 */ 6754 RATE_CTRL_CAPA_AMPDU_TRIGGER = BIT(1), 6755 }; 6756 6757 struct rate_control_ops { 6758 unsigned long capa; 6759 const char *name; 6760 void *(*alloc)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw); 6761 void (*add_debugfs)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, void *priv, 6762 struct dentry *debugfsdir); 6763 void (*free)(void *priv); 6764 6765 void *(*alloc_sta)(void *priv, struct ieee80211_sta *sta, gfp_t gfp); 6766 void (*rate_init)(void *priv, struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband, 6767 struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef, 6768 struct ieee80211_sta *sta, void *priv_sta); 6769 void (*rate_update)(void *priv, struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband, 6770 struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef, 6771 struct ieee80211_sta *sta, void *priv_sta, 6772 u32 changed); 6773 void (*free_sta)(void *priv, struct ieee80211_sta *sta, 6774 void *priv_sta); 6775 6776 void (*tx_status_ext)(void *priv, 6777 struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband, 6778 void *priv_sta, struct ieee80211_tx_status *st); 6779 void (*tx_status)(void *priv, struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband, 6780 struct ieee80211_sta *sta, void *priv_sta, 6781 struct sk_buff *skb); 6782 void (*get_rate)(void *priv, struct ieee80211_sta *sta, void *priv_sta, 6783 struct ieee80211_tx_rate_control *txrc); 6784 6785 void (*add_sta_debugfs)(void *priv, void *priv_sta, 6786 struct dentry *dir); 6787 6788 u32 (*get_expected_throughput)(void *priv_sta); 6789 }; 6790 6791 static inline int rate_supported(struct ieee80211_sta *sta, 6792 enum nl80211_band band, 6793 int index) 6794 { 6795 return (sta == NULL || sta->deflink.supp_rates[band] & BIT(index)); 6796 } 6797 6798 static inline s8 6799 rate_lowest_index(struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband, 6800 struct ieee80211_sta *sta) 6801 { 6802 int i; 6803 6804 for (i = 0; i < sband->n_bitrates; i++) 6805 if (rate_supported(sta, sband->band, i)) 6806 return i; 6807 6808 /* warn when we cannot find a rate. */ 6809 WARN_ON_ONCE(1); 6810 6811 /* and return 0 (the lowest index) */ 6812 return 0; 6813 } 6814 6815 static inline 6816 bool rate_usable_index_exists(struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband, 6817 struct ieee80211_sta *sta) 6818 { 6819 unsigned int i; 6820 6821 for (i = 0; i < sband->n_bitrates; i++) 6822 if (rate_supported(sta, sband->band, i)) 6823 return true; 6824 return false; 6825 } 6826 6827 /** 6828 * rate_control_set_rates - pass the sta rate selection to mac80211/driver 6829 * 6830 * When not doing a rate control probe to test rates, rate control should pass 6831 * its rate selection to mac80211. If the driver supports receiving a station 6832 * rate table, it will use it to ensure that frames are always sent based on 6833 * the most recent rate control module decision. 6834 * 6835 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw() 6836 * @pubsta: &struct ieee80211_sta pointer to the target destination. 6837 * @rates: new tx rate set to be used for this station. 6838 */ 6839 int rate_control_set_rates(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 6840 struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta, 6841 struct ieee80211_sta_rates *rates); 6842 6843 int ieee80211_rate_control_register(const struct rate_control_ops *ops); 6844 void ieee80211_rate_control_unregister(const struct rate_control_ops *ops); 6845 6846 static inline bool 6847 conf_is_ht20(struct ieee80211_conf *conf) 6848 { 6849 return conf->chandef.width == NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_20; 6850 } 6851 6852 static inline bool 6853 conf_is_ht40_minus(struct ieee80211_conf *conf) 6854 { 6855 return conf->chandef.width == NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_40 && 6856 conf->chandef.center_freq1 < conf->chandef.chan->center_freq; 6857 } 6858 6859 static inline bool 6860 conf_is_ht40_plus(struct ieee80211_conf *conf) 6861 { 6862 return conf->chandef.width == NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_40 && 6863 conf->chandef.center_freq1 > conf->chandef.chan->center_freq; 6864 } 6865 6866 static inline bool 6867 conf_is_ht40(struct ieee80211_conf *conf) 6868 { 6869 return conf->chandef.width == NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_40; 6870 } 6871 6872 static inline bool 6873 conf_is_ht(struct ieee80211_conf *conf) 6874 { 6875 return (conf->chandef.width != NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_5) && 6876 (conf->chandef.width != NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_10) && 6877 (conf->chandef.width != NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_20_NOHT); 6878 } 6879 6880 static inline enum nl80211_iftype 6881 ieee80211_iftype_p2p(enum nl80211_iftype type, bool p2p) 6882 { 6883 if (p2p) { 6884 switch (type) { 6885 case NL80211_IFTYPE_STATION: 6886 return NL80211_IFTYPE_P2P_CLIENT; 6887 case NL80211_IFTYPE_AP: 6888 return NL80211_IFTYPE_P2P_GO; 6889 default: 6890 break; 6891 } 6892 } 6893 return type; 6894 } 6895 6896 static inline enum nl80211_iftype 6897 ieee80211_vif_type_p2p(struct ieee80211_vif *vif) 6898 { 6899 return ieee80211_iftype_p2p(vif->type, vif->p2p); 6900 } 6901 6902 /** 6903 * ieee80211_get_he_iftype_cap_vif - return HE capabilities for sband/vif 6904 * @sband: the sband to search for the iftype on 6905 * @vif: the vif to get the iftype from 6906 * 6907 * Return: pointer to the struct ieee80211_sta_he_cap, or %NULL is none found 6908 */ 6909 static inline const struct ieee80211_sta_he_cap * 6910 ieee80211_get_he_iftype_cap_vif(const struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband, 6911 struct ieee80211_vif *vif) 6912 { 6913 return ieee80211_get_he_iftype_cap(sband, ieee80211_vif_type_p2p(vif)); 6914 } 6915 6916 /** 6917 * ieee80211_get_he_6ghz_capa_vif - return HE 6 GHz capabilities 6918 * @sband: the sband to search for the STA on 6919 * @vif: the vif to get the iftype from 6920 * 6921 * Return: the 6GHz capabilities 6922 */ 6923 static inline __le16 6924 ieee80211_get_he_6ghz_capa_vif(const struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband, 6925 struct ieee80211_vif *vif) 6926 { 6927 return ieee80211_get_he_6ghz_capa(sband, ieee80211_vif_type_p2p(vif)); 6928 } 6929 6930 /** 6931 * ieee80211_get_eht_iftype_cap_vif - return ETH capabilities for sband/vif 6932 * @sband: the sband to search for the iftype on 6933 * @vif: the vif to get the iftype from 6934 * 6935 * Return: pointer to the struct ieee80211_sta_eht_cap, or %NULL is none found 6936 */ 6937 static inline const struct ieee80211_sta_eht_cap * 6938 ieee80211_get_eht_iftype_cap_vif(const struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband, 6939 struct ieee80211_vif *vif) 6940 { 6941 return ieee80211_get_eht_iftype_cap(sband, ieee80211_vif_type_p2p(vif)); 6942 } 6943 6944 /** 6945 * ieee80211_update_mu_groups - set the VHT MU-MIMO groud data 6946 * 6947 * @vif: the specified virtual interface 6948 * @link_id: the link ID for MLO, otherwise 0 6949 * @membership: 64 bits array - a bit is set if station is member of the group 6950 * @position: 2 bits per group id indicating the position in the group 6951 * 6952 * Note: This function assumes that the given vif is valid and the position and 6953 * membership data is of the correct size and are in the same byte order as the 6954 * matching GroupId management frame. 6955 * Calls to this function need to be serialized with RX path. 6956 */ 6957 void ieee80211_update_mu_groups(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, unsigned int link_id, 6958 const u8 *membership, const u8 *position); 6959 6960 void ieee80211_enable_rssi_reports(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 6961 int rssi_min_thold, 6962 int rssi_max_thold); 6963 6964 void ieee80211_disable_rssi_reports(struct ieee80211_vif *vif); 6965 6966 /** 6967 * ieee80211_ave_rssi - report the average RSSI for the specified interface 6968 * 6969 * @vif: the specified virtual interface 6970 * 6971 * Note: This function assumes that the given vif is valid. 6972 * 6973 * Return: The average RSSI value for the requested interface, or 0 if not 6974 * applicable. 6975 */ 6976 int ieee80211_ave_rssi(struct ieee80211_vif *vif); 6977 6978 /** 6979 * ieee80211_report_wowlan_wakeup - report WoWLAN wakeup 6980 * @vif: virtual interface 6981 * @wakeup: wakeup reason(s) 6982 * @gfp: allocation flags 6983 * 6984 * See cfg80211_report_wowlan_wakeup(). 6985 */ 6986 void ieee80211_report_wowlan_wakeup(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 6987 struct cfg80211_wowlan_wakeup *wakeup, 6988 gfp_t gfp); 6989 6990 /** 6991 * ieee80211_tx_prepare_skb - prepare an 802.11 skb for transmission 6992 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw() 6993 * @vif: virtual interface 6994 * @skb: frame to be sent from within the driver 6995 * @band: the band to transmit on 6996 * @sta: optional pointer to get the station to send the frame to 6997 * 6998 * Note: must be called under RCU lock 6999 */ 7000 bool ieee80211_tx_prepare_skb(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 7001 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, struct sk_buff *skb, 7002 int band, struct ieee80211_sta **sta); 7003 7004 /** 7005 * ieee80211_parse_tx_radiotap - Sanity-check and parse the radiotap header 7006 * of injected frames. 7007 * 7008 * To accurately parse and take into account rate and retransmission fields, 7009 * you must initialize the chandef field in the ieee80211_tx_info structure 7010 * of the skb before calling this function. 7011 * 7012 * @skb: packet injected by userspace 7013 * @dev: the &struct device of this 802.11 device 7014 */ 7015 bool ieee80211_parse_tx_radiotap(struct sk_buff *skb, 7016 struct net_device *dev); 7017 7018 /** 7019 * struct ieee80211_noa_data - holds temporary data for tracking P2P NoA state 7020 * 7021 * @next_tsf: TSF timestamp of the next absent state change 7022 * @has_next_tsf: next absent state change event pending 7023 * 7024 * @absent: descriptor bitmask, set if GO is currently absent 7025 * 7026 * private: 7027 * 7028 * @count: count fields from the NoA descriptors 7029 * @desc: adjusted data from the NoA 7030 */ 7031 struct ieee80211_noa_data { 7032 u32 next_tsf; 7033 bool has_next_tsf; 7034 7035 u8 absent; 7036 7037 u8 count[IEEE80211_P2P_NOA_DESC_MAX]; 7038 struct { 7039 u32 start; 7040 u32 duration; 7041 u32 interval; 7042 } desc[IEEE80211_P2P_NOA_DESC_MAX]; 7043 }; 7044 7045 /** 7046 * ieee80211_parse_p2p_noa - initialize NoA tracking data from P2P IE 7047 * 7048 * @attr: P2P NoA IE 7049 * @data: NoA tracking data 7050 * @tsf: current TSF timestamp 7051 * 7052 * Return: number of successfully parsed descriptors 7053 */ 7054 int ieee80211_parse_p2p_noa(const struct ieee80211_p2p_noa_attr *attr, 7055 struct ieee80211_noa_data *data, u32 tsf); 7056 7057 /** 7058 * ieee80211_update_p2p_noa - get next pending P2P GO absent state change 7059 * 7060 * @data: NoA tracking data 7061 * @tsf: current TSF timestamp 7062 */ 7063 void ieee80211_update_p2p_noa(struct ieee80211_noa_data *data, u32 tsf); 7064 7065 /** 7066 * ieee80211_tdls_oper_request - request userspace to perform a TDLS operation 7067 * @vif: virtual interface 7068 * @peer: the peer's destination address 7069 * @oper: the requested TDLS operation 7070 * @reason_code: reason code for the operation, valid for TDLS teardown 7071 * @gfp: allocation flags 7072 * 7073 * See cfg80211_tdls_oper_request(). 7074 */ 7075 void ieee80211_tdls_oper_request(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, const u8 *peer, 7076 enum nl80211_tdls_operation oper, 7077 u16 reason_code, gfp_t gfp); 7078 7079 /** 7080 * ieee80211_reserve_tid - request to reserve a specific TID 7081 * 7082 * There is sometimes a need (such as in TDLS) for blocking the driver from 7083 * using a specific TID so that the FW can use it for certain operations such 7084 * as sending PTI requests. To make sure that the driver doesn't use that TID, 7085 * this function must be called as it flushes out packets on this TID and marks 7086 * it as blocked, so that any transmit for the station on this TID will be 7087 * redirected to the alternative TID in the same AC. 7088 * 7089 * Note that this function blocks and may call back into the driver, so it 7090 * should be called without driver locks held. Also note this function should 7091 * only be called from the driver's @sta_state callback. 7092 * 7093 * @sta: the station to reserve the TID for 7094 * @tid: the TID to reserve 7095 * 7096 * Returns: 0 on success, else on failure 7097 */ 7098 int ieee80211_reserve_tid(struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u8 tid); 7099 7100 /** 7101 * ieee80211_unreserve_tid - request to unreserve a specific TID 7102 * 7103 * Once there is no longer any need for reserving a certain TID, this function 7104 * should be called, and no longer will packets have their TID modified for 7105 * preventing use of this TID in the driver. 7106 * 7107 * Note that this function blocks and acquires a lock, so it should be called 7108 * without driver locks held. Also note this function should only be called 7109 * from the driver's @sta_state callback. 7110 * 7111 * @sta: the station 7112 * @tid: the TID to unreserve 7113 */ 7114 void ieee80211_unreserve_tid(struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u8 tid); 7115 7116 /** 7117 * ieee80211_tx_dequeue - dequeue a packet from a software tx queue 7118 * 7119 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw() 7120 * @txq: pointer obtained from station or virtual interface, or from 7121 * ieee80211_next_txq() 7122 * 7123 * Returns the skb if successful, %NULL if no frame was available. 7124 * 7125 * Note that this must be called in an rcu_read_lock() critical section, 7126 * which can only be released after the SKB was handled. Some pointers in 7127 * skb->cb, e.g. the key pointer, are protected by RCU and thus the 7128 * critical section must persist not just for the duration of this call 7129 * but for the duration of the frame handling. 7130 * However, also note that while in the wake_tx_queue() method, 7131 * rcu_read_lock() is already held. 7132 * 7133 * softirqs must also be disabled when this function is called. 7134 * In process context, use ieee80211_tx_dequeue_ni() instead. 7135 */ 7136 struct sk_buff *ieee80211_tx_dequeue(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 7137 struct ieee80211_txq *txq); 7138 7139 /** 7140 * ieee80211_tx_dequeue_ni - dequeue a packet from a software tx queue 7141 * (in process context) 7142 * 7143 * Like ieee80211_tx_dequeue() but can be called in process context 7144 * (internally disables bottom halves). 7145 * 7146 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw() 7147 * @txq: pointer obtained from station or virtual interface, or from 7148 * ieee80211_next_txq() 7149 */ 7150 static inline struct sk_buff *ieee80211_tx_dequeue_ni(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 7151 struct ieee80211_txq *txq) 7152 { 7153 struct sk_buff *skb; 7154 7155 local_bh_disable(); 7156 skb = ieee80211_tx_dequeue(hw, txq); 7157 local_bh_enable(); 7158 7159 return skb; 7160 } 7161 7162 /** 7163 * ieee80211_handle_wake_tx_queue - mac80211 handler for wake_tx_queue callback 7164 * 7165 * @hw: pointer as obtained from wake_tx_queue() callback(). 7166 * @txq: pointer as obtained from wake_tx_queue() callback(). 7167 * 7168 * Drivers can use this function for the mandatory mac80211 wake_tx_queue 7169 * callback in struct ieee80211_ops. They should not call this function. 7170 */ 7171 void ieee80211_handle_wake_tx_queue(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 7172 struct ieee80211_txq *txq); 7173 7174 /** 7175 * ieee80211_next_txq - get next tx queue to pull packets from 7176 * 7177 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw() 7178 * @ac: AC number to return packets from. 7179 * 7180 * Returns the next txq if successful, %NULL if no queue is eligible. If a txq 7181 * is returned, it should be returned with ieee80211_return_txq() after the 7182 * driver has finished scheduling it. 7183 */ 7184 struct ieee80211_txq *ieee80211_next_txq(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u8 ac); 7185 7186 /** 7187 * ieee80211_txq_schedule_start - start new scheduling round for TXQs 7188 * 7189 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw() 7190 * @ac: AC number to acquire locks for 7191 * 7192 * Should be called before ieee80211_next_txq() or ieee80211_return_txq(). 7193 * The driver must not call multiple TXQ scheduling rounds concurrently. 7194 */ 7195 void ieee80211_txq_schedule_start(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u8 ac); 7196 7197 /* (deprecated) */ 7198 static inline void ieee80211_txq_schedule_end(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u8 ac) 7199 { 7200 } 7201 7202 void __ieee80211_schedule_txq(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 7203 struct ieee80211_txq *txq, bool force); 7204 7205 /** 7206 * ieee80211_schedule_txq - schedule a TXQ for transmission 7207 * 7208 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw() 7209 * @txq: pointer obtained from station or virtual interface 7210 * 7211 * Schedules a TXQ for transmission if it is not already scheduled, 7212 * even if mac80211 does not have any packets buffered. 7213 * 7214 * The driver may call this function if it has buffered packets for 7215 * this TXQ internally. 7216 */ 7217 static inline void 7218 ieee80211_schedule_txq(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_txq *txq) 7219 { 7220 __ieee80211_schedule_txq(hw, txq, true); 7221 } 7222 7223 /** 7224 * ieee80211_return_txq - return a TXQ previously acquired by ieee80211_next_txq() 7225 * 7226 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw() 7227 * @txq: pointer obtained from station or virtual interface 7228 * @force: schedule txq even if mac80211 does not have any buffered packets. 7229 * 7230 * The driver may set force=true if it has buffered packets for this TXQ 7231 * internally. 7232 */ 7233 static inline void 7234 ieee80211_return_txq(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_txq *txq, 7235 bool force) 7236 { 7237 __ieee80211_schedule_txq(hw, txq, force); 7238 } 7239 7240 /** 7241 * ieee80211_txq_may_transmit - check whether TXQ is allowed to transmit 7242 * 7243 * This function is used to check whether given txq is allowed to transmit by 7244 * the airtime scheduler, and can be used by drivers to access the airtime 7245 * fairness accounting without going using the scheduling order enfored by 7246 * next_txq(). 7247 * 7248 * Returns %true if the airtime scheduler thinks the TXQ should be allowed to 7249 * transmit, and %false if it should be throttled. This function can also have 7250 * the side effect of rotating the TXQ in the scheduler rotation, which will 7251 * eventually bring the deficit to positive and allow the station to transmit 7252 * again. 7253 * 7254 * The API ieee80211_txq_may_transmit() also ensures that TXQ list will be 7255 * aligned against driver's own round-robin scheduler list. i.e it rotates 7256 * the TXQ list till it makes the requested node becomes the first entry 7257 * in TXQ list. Thus both the TXQ list and driver's list are in sync. If this 7258 * function returns %true, the driver is expected to schedule packets 7259 * for transmission, and then return the TXQ through ieee80211_return_txq(). 7260 * 7261 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw() 7262 * @txq: pointer obtained from station or virtual interface 7263 */ 7264 bool ieee80211_txq_may_transmit(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 7265 struct ieee80211_txq *txq); 7266 7267 /** 7268 * ieee80211_txq_get_depth - get pending frame/byte count of given txq 7269 * 7270 * The values are not guaranteed to be coherent with regard to each other, i.e. 7271 * txq state can change half-way of this function and the caller may end up 7272 * with "new" frame_cnt and "old" byte_cnt or vice-versa. 7273 * 7274 * @txq: pointer obtained from station or virtual interface 7275 * @frame_cnt: pointer to store frame count 7276 * @byte_cnt: pointer to store byte count 7277 */ 7278 void ieee80211_txq_get_depth(struct ieee80211_txq *txq, 7279 unsigned long *frame_cnt, 7280 unsigned long *byte_cnt); 7281 7282 /** 7283 * ieee80211_nan_func_terminated - notify about NAN function termination. 7284 * 7285 * This function is used to notify mac80211 about NAN function termination. 7286 * Note that this function can't be called from hard irq. 7287 * 7288 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback. 7289 * @inst_id: the local instance id 7290 * @reason: termination reason (one of the NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TERM_REASON_*) 7291 * @gfp: allocation flags 7292 */ 7293 void ieee80211_nan_func_terminated(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 7294 u8 inst_id, 7295 enum nl80211_nan_func_term_reason reason, 7296 gfp_t gfp); 7297 7298 /** 7299 * ieee80211_nan_func_match - notify about NAN function match event. 7300 * 7301 * This function is used to notify mac80211 about NAN function match. The 7302 * cookie inside the match struct will be assigned by mac80211. 7303 * Note that this function can't be called from hard irq. 7304 * 7305 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback. 7306 * @match: match event information 7307 * @gfp: allocation flags 7308 */ 7309 void ieee80211_nan_func_match(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 7310 struct cfg80211_nan_match_params *match, 7311 gfp_t gfp); 7312 7313 /** 7314 * ieee80211_calc_rx_airtime - calculate estimated transmission airtime for RX. 7315 * 7316 * This function calculates the estimated airtime usage of a frame based on the 7317 * rate information in the RX status struct and the frame length. 7318 * 7319 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw() 7320 * @status: &struct ieee80211_rx_status containing the transmission rate 7321 * information. 7322 * @len: frame length in bytes 7323 */ 7324 u32 ieee80211_calc_rx_airtime(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 7325 struct ieee80211_rx_status *status, 7326 int len); 7327 7328 /** 7329 * ieee80211_calc_tx_airtime - calculate estimated transmission airtime for TX. 7330 * 7331 * This function calculates the estimated airtime usage of a frame based on the 7332 * rate information in the TX info struct and the frame length. 7333 * 7334 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw() 7335 * @info: &struct ieee80211_tx_info of the frame. 7336 * @len: frame length in bytes 7337 */ 7338 u32 ieee80211_calc_tx_airtime(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 7339 struct ieee80211_tx_info *info, 7340 int len); 7341 /** 7342 * ieee80211_set_hw_80211_encap - enable hardware encapsulation offloading. 7343 * 7344 * This function is used to notify mac80211 that a vif can be passed raw 802.3 7345 * frames. The driver needs to then handle the 802.11 encapsulation inside the 7346 * hardware or firmware. 7347 * 7348 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback. 7349 * @enable: indicate if the feature should be turned on or off 7350 */ 7351 bool ieee80211_set_hw_80211_encap(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, bool enable); 7352 7353 /** 7354 * ieee80211_get_fils_discovery_tmpl - Get FILS discovery template. 7355 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw(). 7356 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback. 7357 * 7358 * The driver is responsible for freeing the returned skb. 7359 * 7360 * Return: FILS discovery template. %NULL on error. 7361 */ 7362 struct sk_buff *ieee80211_get_fils_discovery_tmpl(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 7363 struct ieee80211_vif *vif); 7364 7365 /** 7366 * ieee80211_get_unsol_bcast_probe_resp_tmpl - Get unsolicited broadcast 7367 * probe response template. 7368 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw(). 7369 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback. 7370 * 7371 * The driver is responsible for freeing the returned skb. 7372 * 7373 * Return: Unsolicited broadcast probe response template. %NULL on error. 7374 */ 7375 struct sk_buff * 7376 ieee80211_get_unsol_bcast_probe_resp_tmpl(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 7377 struct ieee80211_vif *vif); 7378 7379 /** 7380 * ieee80211_obss_color_collision_notify - notify userland about a BSS color 7381 * collision. 7382 * 7383 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback. 7384 * @color_bitmap: a 64 bit bitmap representing the colors that the local BSS is 7385 * aware of. 7386 * @gfp: allocation flags 7387 */ 7388 void 7389 ieee80211_obss_color_collision_notify(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 7390 u64 color_bitmap, gfp_t gfp); 7391 7392 /** 7393 * ieee80211_is_tx_data - check if frame is a data frame 7394 * 7395 * The function is used to check if a frame is a data frame. Frames with 7396 * hardware encapsulation enabled are data frames. 7397 * 7398 * @skb: the frame to be transmitted. 7399 */ 7400 static inline bool ieee80211_is_tx_data(struct sk_buff *skb) 7401 { 7402 struct ieee80211_tx_info *info = IEEE80211_SKB_CB(skb); 7403 struct ieee80211_hdr *hdr = (void *) skb->data; 7404 7405 return info->flags & IEEE80211_TX_CTL_HW_80211_ENCAP || 7406 ieee80211_is_data(hdr->frame_control); 7407 } 7408 7409 /** 7410 * ieee80211_set_active_links - set active links in client mode 7411 * @vif: interface to set active links on 7412 * @active_links: the new active links bitmap 7413 * 7414 * This changes the active links on an interface. The interface 7415 * must be in client mode (in AP mode, all links are always active), 7416 * and @active_links must be a subset of the vif's valid_links. 7417 * 7418 * If a link is switched off and another is switched on at the same 7419 * time (e.g. active_links going from 0x1 to 0x10) then you will get 7420 * a sequence of calls like 7421 * - change_vif_links(0x11) 7422 * - unassign_vif_chanctx(link_id=0) 7423 * - change_sta_links(0x11) for each affected STA (the AP) 7424 * (TDLS connections on now inactive links should be torn down) 7425 * - remove group keys on the old link (link_id 0) 7426 * - add new group keys (GTK/IGTK/BIGTK) on the new link (link_id 4) 7427 * - change_sta_links(0x10) for each affected STA (the AP) 7428 * - assign_vif_chanctx(link_id=4) 7429 * - change_vif_links(0x10) 7430 * 7431 * Note: This function acquires some mac80211 locks and must not 7432 * be called with any driver locks held that could cause a 7433 * lock dependency inversion. Best call it without locks. 7434 */ 7435 int ieee80211_set_active_links(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, u16 active_links); 7436 7437 /** 7438 * ieee80211_set_active_links_async - asynchronously set active links 7439 * @vif: interface to set active links on 7440 * @active_links: the new active links bitmap 7441 * 7442 * See ieee80211_set_active_links() for more information, the only 7443 * difference here is that the link change is triggered async and 7444 * can be called in any context, but the link switch will only be 7445 * completed after it returns. 7446 */ 7447 void ieee80211_set_active_links_async(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 7448 u16 active_links); 7449 7450 #endif /* MAC80211_H */ 7451